]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
(rx-not): Bind case-fold-search to nil.
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 See the end for copying conditions.
4
5 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
6 For older news, see the file ONEWS
7
8 Temporary note:
9 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
10 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
11 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
12 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
13
14 \f
15 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.4
16
17 ---
18 ** A Bulgarian translation of the Emacs Tutorial is available.
19
20 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
21 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
22 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
23
24 ---
25 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
26
27 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
28
29 ---
30 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
31 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
32 installed programs.
33
34 ---
35 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
36 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
37 place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
38 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
39 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
40 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
41 in each user's home directory.
42
43 ---
44 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
45 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
46 Emacs with Leim.
47
48 +++
49 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
50
51 The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
52 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
53 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
54 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
55
56 ---
57 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
58 the distribution.
59
60 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
61 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
62 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
63 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
64
65 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
66
67 ---
68 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
69
70 ---
71 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
72
73 ---
74 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
75 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
76
77 ---
78 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
79
80 ---
81 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
82
83 ---
84 ** A French translation of the Emacs Tutorial is available.
85 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
86 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
87
88 \f
89 * Changes in Emacs 21.4
90
91 ** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
92 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
93 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
94 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
95 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
96
97 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' may be set to nil to
98 revert to the old behaviour of continuing such lines.
99
100 ** The buffer boundaries (i.e. first and last line in the buffer) may
101 now be marked with angle bitmaps in the fringes. In addition, up and
102 down arrow bitmaps may be shown at the top and bottom of the left or
103 right fringe if the window can be scrolled in either direction.
104
105 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
106 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
107 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
108
109 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
110 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp. Any other non-nil value
111 causes the bitmap on the top line to be displayed in the left fringe,
112 and the bitmap on the bottom line in the right fringe.
113
114 If value is a cons (ANGLES . ARROWS), the car specifies the position
115 of the angle bitmaps, and the cdr specifies the position of the arrow
116 bitmaps.
117
118 For example, (t . right) places the top angle bitmap in left fringe,
119 the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both arrow bitmaps in
120 right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the left fringe, but
121 no arrow bitmaps, use (left . nil).
122
123 ** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
124 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
125 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
126 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
127 keyboard oriented alternative.
128
129 ** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
130 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
131 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
132 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
133 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
134
135 ** New commands `scan-buf-next-region' and `scan-buf-previous-region'
136 move to the start of the next (previous, respectively) region with
137 non-nil help-echo property and display any help found there in the
138 echo area, using `display-local-help'.
139
140 +++
141 ** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
142 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
143 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
144 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
145 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
146 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
147 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
148
149 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
150 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
151
152 +++
153 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
154 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
155 an interactively callable function.
156
157
158 ** sql changes.
159
160 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
161 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
162 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
163 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
164 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
165
166 The following values are supported:
167
168 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
169 db2 DB2
170 informix Informix
171 ingres Ingres
172 interbase Interbase
173 linter Linter
174 ms Microsoft
175 mysql MySQL
176 oracle Oracle
177 postgres Postgres
178 solid Solid
179 sqlite SQLite
180 sybase Sybase
181
182 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
183 SQL mode indicator.
184
185 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
186 your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
187 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
188
189 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
190 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
191 all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
192 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
193
194 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
195 '("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face))
196
197 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
198 SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
199 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
200
201 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
202 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
203 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
204 osql flushes it's error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
205 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
206 terminated.
207
208 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
209 called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
210 credentials to authenticate the user.
211
212 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
213 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
214 defaults.
215
216 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
217 appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
218 `sql-product'.
219
220 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
221 with special modes such as Tar mode.
222
223 ** Enhancements to apropos commands:
224
225 *** The apropos commands will now accept a list of words to match.
226 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
227 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
228 available.
229
230 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
231 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
232 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
233 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
234 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
235 matching item.
236
237 +++
238 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
239 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
240 the operating system or your X server.
241
242 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
243 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
244 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
245
246 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
247 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
248
249 +++
250 ** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
251 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
252 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
253
254 ** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
255 'sql-sqlite'.
256
257 ** BibTeX mode:
258 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
259 *** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
260 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
261 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
262 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
263 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
264 bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
265
266 *** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
267 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
268
269 *** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
270 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
271
272 *** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
273 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
274
275 *** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
276 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
277
278 *** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
279 locate entries and crossref'd entries.
280
281 *** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
282 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
283
284 ** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
285 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
286 at the edges of the window.
287
288 ** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
289 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
290
291 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
292 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
293 or when the frame is resized.
294
295 ** New functions frame-current-scroll-bars and window-current-scroll-bars.
296
297 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
298 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
299
300 ---
301 ** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
302 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
303 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
304
305 ** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
306
307 ** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
308 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
309
310 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
311 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
312
313 ** `describe-char' can show data from the Unicode database file. See
314 user option `unicode-data'.
315
316 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
317
318 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
319 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
320
321 ** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
322 Emacs will prompt her for confirmation.
323
324 ** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
325
326 ** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
327 and other common debugger commands.
328
329 ** recentf changes.
330
331 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
332 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
333 automatic cleanup.
334
335 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
336 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
337 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
338 recent list with different symbolic links.
339
340 To follow naming convention, `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-flag'
341 and `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag' respectively replace the
342 misnamed options `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p' and
343 `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The old names remain available as
344 aliases, but have been marked obsolete.
345
346 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
347 from the locale.
348
349 ** Init file changes
350
351 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
352 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
353
354 ** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
355
356 ** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
357 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
358 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
359 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
360 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
361 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
362
363 ** MH-E changes.
364
365 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.3. There have been major changes since
366 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
367
368 +++
369 ** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
370 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
371 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
372
373 ** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
374
375 +++
376 ** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
377 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
378 appears between the position information and the major mode.
379
380 ** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
381 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
382
383 +++
384 ** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
385 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
386 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
387 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
388 set-fringe-style.
389
390 +++
391 ** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
392 to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
393 directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
394 "~/".
395
396 +++
397 ** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
398 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
399 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you will in fact be able
400 to alter the file.)
401
402 ** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
403 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
404
405 ** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
406 of a file.
407
408 ---
409 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
410
411 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
412 ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
413 See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
414
415 ---
416 ** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
417 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
418 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
419
420 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
421 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
422 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories will be
423 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
424 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
425
426 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
427 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
428 t, and the status is shown.
429
430 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
431 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
432
433 +++
434 ** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
435 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
436 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
437 faces.
438
439 ** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
440 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
441 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
442 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
443 automatically according to the locale.)
444
445 ** Indian support has been updated.
446 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
447 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
448 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
449 supported.
450
451 ---
452 ** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
453 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
454 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
455 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
456 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
457 tamil-inscript.
458
459 ---
460 ** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
461 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
462 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
463
464 ---
465 ** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
466 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
467 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
468 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
469 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
470 latter is used by GNU locales.
471
472 ** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
473 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences (mostly representing CJK
474 characters) are simply composed into single quasi-characters. User
475 option `utf-translate-cjk' arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK
476 character sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the
477 Mule-UCS system. This uses significant space, so is not the default.
478 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
479 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
480 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
481 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
482 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
483
484 ** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
485 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
486 fontset appropriately.
487
488 ** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
489 unicode.
490
491 +++
492 ** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
493 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
494 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
495 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
496 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
497 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
498 mule-unicode-... ones.
499
500 By default this translation will happen automatically on encoding.
501 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
502 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
503 possible.
504
505 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
506 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
507 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
508 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
509 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
510
511 ** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
512 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
513 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
514 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
515
516 ** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
517 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
518 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
519 command.
520
521 ---
522 ** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
523 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
524 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
525
526 ---
527 ** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
528 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+ and W32).
529
530 ---
531 ** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif pops down when pressing ESC.
532
533 +++
534 ** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
535 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
536
537 +++
538 ** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
539 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
540 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
541 cursor does.
542
543 +++
544 ** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
545 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
546
547 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
548 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
549 program files that include other program files.
550
551 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
552 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
553 in them.
554
555 ---
556 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
557 when Emacs visits them.
558
559 ---
560 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
561
562 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
563 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
564 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
565
566 ** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
567 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
568 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
569 and use the more appropriately result.
570
571 +++
572 ** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
573 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
574 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
575 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
576
577 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
578 hscrolling will scroll the window when point gets too close to the
579 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
580 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
581 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
582 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
583
584 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
585 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
586
587 ** TeX modes:
588 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
589 +++
590 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
591 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
592 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
593 TeX commands to use at startup.
594 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
595 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
596
597 *** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
598
599 +++
600 ** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
601 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
602 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
603 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
604 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
605 feature is not enabled.
606
607 +++
608 ** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
609 description various information about a character, including its
610 encodings and syntax, its text properties, overlays, and widgets at
611 point. You can get more information about some of them, by clicking
612 on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
613
614 +++
615 ** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
616 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
617 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
618 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
619 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
620
621 +++
622 ** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
623 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
624 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
625 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
626 also disable mouse highlighting.
627
628 +++
629 ** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
630 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
631 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
632 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
633 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
634
635 +++
636 ** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
637 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
638 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
639 prompt string.
640
641 +++
642 ** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
643 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
644 the mode line of the currently selected window.
645
646 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
647 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
648
649 ---
650 ** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
651 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
652 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
653 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
654 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
655 current date and time, current line and column number in the
656 mode-line.
657
658 ---
659 ** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
660
661 +++
662 ** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
663 in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
664 `display-time-mail-directory'.
665
666 +++
667 ** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
668
669 ---
670 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
671
672 +++
673 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
674 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
675 argument it toggles the mode.
676
677 Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
678 that were replaced by turning on the mode.
679
680 +++
681 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
682 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
683 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
684 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
685 `inhibit-splash-screen').
686
687 ** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
688
689 +++
690 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
691 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
692 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
693 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
694 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
695 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
696 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
697 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
698 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
699
700 ---
701 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
702 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
703 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
704 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
705 all of these colors.
706
707 ---
708 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
709
710 +++
711 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
712
713 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
714 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
715 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
716 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
717
718 ---
719 ** Info-index offers completion.
720
721 ---
722 ** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
723 automatically.
724
725 +++
726 ** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
727 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
728 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
729 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
730
731 +++
732 ** Changes in C-h bindings:
733
734 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
735
736 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
737 that do not change:
738
739 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
740 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
741
742 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
743 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
744
745 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
746
747 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
748 run by the key sequence.
749
750 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
751 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
752 that command.
753
754 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
755 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
756
757 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
758 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
759
760 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
761 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
762
763 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
764 new-kill-line is on C-k
765
766 +++
767 ** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
768 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
769 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
770 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
771
772 +++
773 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
774 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
775 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
776 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
777
778 +++
779 ** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
780 M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
781 `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
782 remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
783
784 +++
785 ** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
786 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep will automatically
787 detect whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
788 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
789 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
790 command lines to be used than was possible before.
791
792 ---
793 ** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
794 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
795 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
796 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
797 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
798 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
799 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
800
801 +++
802 ** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
803 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
804 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
805 under the "[State]" button.
806
807 ** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
808 point (no integers are allowed).
809
810 +++
811 ** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
812 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
813
814 ---
815 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
816
817 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
818 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
819 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
820 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
821 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
822
823 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
824 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
825 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
826 (gud-finish).
827
828 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
829 (Java 1.1 jdb).
830
831 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
832 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
833 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
834
835 Added Customization Variables
836
837 *** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
838
839 *** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
840 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
841 java sources (previous method).
842
843 *** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
844 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
845 is nil).
846
847 Minor Improvements
848
849 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
850
851 +++
852 ** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
853 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
854 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
855
856 +++
857 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
858 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
859 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
860 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
861 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
862 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
863
864 +++
865 ** Dired's v command now runs external viewers to view certain
866 types of files. The variable `dired-view-command-alist' controls
867 what external viewers to use and when.
868
869 +++
870 ** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
871 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
872 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
873 is only rarely needed.
874
875 ---
876 ** JIT-lock changes
877 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
878
879 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
880 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
881 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
882 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
883
884 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
885
886 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
887 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
888 refontification takes place.
889
890 +++
891 ** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
892 you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
893 C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region will now be extended
894 each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC,
895 for example. This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you
896 bind that to a key.
897
898 +++
899 ** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
900 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
901 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
902 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
903 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
904 command only.
905
906 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
907 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
908 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
909 mark or the region.
910
911 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
912 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
913 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
914 C-g.
915
916 +++
917 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
918 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... will cycle through the
919 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
920
921 +++
922 ** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
923 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
924 switching to it.
925
926 +++
927 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
928 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
929 affects the initial frame.
930
931 +++
932 ** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
933 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
934 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
935 paragraphs.
936
937 ** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
938 into the kill ring.
939
940 +++
941 ** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
942 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
943 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
944 directory listing into a buffer.
945
946 ---
947 ** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
948 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
949
950 ** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
951 wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
952 This behaviour can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
953 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
954
955 +++
956 ** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
957 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
958 may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
959 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
960 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
961 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
962 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
963 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
964
965 +++
966 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
967 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
968 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
969 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
970 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
971
972 +++
973 ** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
974 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
975 appears in.
976
977 ** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
978 of the recognized cursor types.
979
980 ---
981 ** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
982 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
983 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
984
985 +++
986 ** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
987 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
988 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
989 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
990 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
991 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
992 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
993 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
994 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
995
996 +++
997 ** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
998 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
999 count backward from the end of the year.
1000
1001 ** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
1002 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
1003 and `diary-header-line-format'.
1004
1005 +++
1006 ** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
1007 the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
1008 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
1009 appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
1010
1011 ** VC Changes
1012
1013 *** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
1014 the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
1015 change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
1016 with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
1017 can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
1018
1019 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
1020
1021 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
1022
1023 +++
1024 *** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
1025 you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
1026 by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
1027 means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
1028 allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
1029 CVS.
1030
1031 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
1032
1033 ** EDiff changes.
1034
1035 +++
1036 *** When comparing directories.
1037 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
1038 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
1039 from one directory to another.
1040
1041 +++
1042 *** When comparing files or buffers.
1043 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
1044 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
1045 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
1046 comparison.
1047
1048 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
1049 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
1050 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
1051
1052 +++
1053 ** Etags changes.
1054
1055 *** New regular expressions features
1056
1057 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
1058 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
1059 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
1060 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
1061 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
1062 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
1063 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
1064 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
1065 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
1066 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
1067 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
1068
1069 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
1070 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
1071 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
1072 CR, TAB, VT,
1073
1074 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
1075 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
1076 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
1077 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
1078
1079 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
1080 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
1081 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
1082
1083 *** New language parsing features
1084
1085 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
1086 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
1087
1088 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
1089 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
1090 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
1091 package::sub.
1092
1093 **** New language PHP.
1094 Tags are functions, classes and defines.
1095 If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are vars also.
1096
1097 **** New language HTML.
1098 Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
1099 used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
1100
1101 **** New default keywords for TeX.
1102 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
1103 renewenvironment.
1104
1105 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
1106 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
1107 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
1108
1109 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
1110
1111 *** Honour #line directives.
1112 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
1113 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
1114 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
1115 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
1116 writes tags pointing to the source file.
1117
1118 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
1119 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
1120 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
1121 will read from standard input and mark the produced tags as belonging to
1122 the file FILE.
1123
1124 +++
1125 ** CC Mode changes.
1126
1127 *** Font lock support.
1128 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1129 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1130 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1131 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1132 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1133 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1134
1135 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1136 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1137 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1138 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1139 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1140 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1141 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1142 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1143 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1144
1145 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1146 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1147 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1148 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1149 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1150 take the better part of a minute.
1151
1152 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1153 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1154 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1155 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1156 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1157 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1158
1159 **** Support for documentation comments.
1160 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1161 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1162 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1163 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1164
1165 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1166 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1167 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1168 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1169
1170 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1171 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1172 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1173 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1174 parens.
1175
1176 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1177 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1178 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1179 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1180 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1181
1182 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1183 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1184 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1185 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1186 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1187
1188 *** Support for the AWK language.
1189 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1190 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1191 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1192 Here is a summary:
1193
1194 **** Indentation Engine
1195 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1196
1197 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1198 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1199 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1200 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1201 definition, or structured statement.
1202
1203 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1204 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1205 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1206
1207 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1208 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1209 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1210 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1211
1212 **** Font Locking
1213 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1214 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1215 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1216 the AWK language itself.
1217
1218 **** Comment Commands
1219 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1220 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1221
1222 **** Movement Commands
1223 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1224 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1225 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1226
1227 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1228 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1229 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1230 functions.
1231
1232 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1233 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1234 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1235 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1236
1237 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1238 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1239 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1240 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1241 composition-close, and incomposition.
1242
1243 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1244 The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
1245 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1246 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1247
1248 *** Better control over require-final-newline.
1249 The variable that controls how to handle a final newline when the
1250 buffer is saved, require-final-newline, is now customizable on a
1251 per-mode basis through c-require-final-newline. The default is to set
1252 it to t only in languages that mandate a final newline in source files
1253 (C, C++ and Objective-C).
1254
1255 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1256 The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
1257 and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
1258 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
1259 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
1260
1261 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
1262
1263 is now analysed as
1264
1265 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
1266
1267 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
1268 symbol.
1269
1270 This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
1271 and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
1272 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
1273 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
1274
1275 *** API changes for derived modes.
1276 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
1277 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
1278 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
1279 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
1280 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
1281
1282 **** New language variable system.
1283 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
1284
1285 **** New initialization functions.
1286 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
1287 give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
1288 c-init-language-vars.
1289
1290 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
1291 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
1292 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
1293 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
1294
1295 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
1296 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
1297 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
1298 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
1299 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1300
1301 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
1302 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
1303 its substatement. E.g:
1304
1305 if (x)
1306 x_is_true:
1307 do_stuff();
1308
1309 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
1310
1311 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
1312 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
1313 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
1314 variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
1315 cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
1316 inside #define's.
1317
1318 **** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
1319 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
1320 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
1321 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
1322 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
1323 much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
1324 empty lines within the macro better.
1325
1326 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
1327 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
1328 c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
1329
1330 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1331 c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
1332 variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
1333 backslashes can be moved.
1334
1335 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1336 This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
1337 affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
1338 inserted in auto-newline mode.
1339
1340 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
1341 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
1342 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
1343 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
1344 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
1345 backslash) in the macro.
1346
1347 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
1348 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
1349 the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
1350 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
1351 and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
1352 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
1353
1354 *** New function c-context-open-line.
1355 It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
1356
1357 *** New lineup functions
1358
1359 **** c-lineup-string-cont
1360 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
1361 continues. E.g:
1362
1363 result = prefix + "A message "
1364 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
1365
1366 **** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
1367 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
1368
1369 **** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
1370 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
1371 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
1372
1373 **** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
1374 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
1375 Ryde.
1376
1377 **** c-lineup-argcont
1378 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
1379 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1380
1381 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
1382 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
1383 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
1384 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
1385 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
1386 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
1387
1388 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
1389 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
1390 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
1391 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
1392 context.
1393
1394 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
1395 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
1396 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
1397 happen when macros are involved.
1398
1399 *** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
1400 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
1401 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
1402 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
1403 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
1404 line is left untouched.
1405
1406 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
1407 The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
1408 syntactic indentation.
1409
1410 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
1411 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
1412
1413 +++
1414 ** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
1415 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
1416
1417 +++
1418 ** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1419 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1420 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1421
1422 +++
1423 ** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
1424 filling can break lines. We provide two sample predicates,
1425 fill-single-word-nobreak-p and fill-french-nobreak-p.
1426
1427 +++
1428 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1429 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry will always
1430 start a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1431
1432 +++
1433 ** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
1434 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
1435 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
1436 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
1437 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
1438 from the file name or buffer contents.
1439
1440 +++
1441 ** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
1442
1443 +++
1444 ** New user option `isearch-resume-enabled'.
1445 This option can be disabled, to avoid the normal behavior of isearch
1446 which puts calls to `isearch-resume' in the command history.
1447
1448 ---
1449 ** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
1450
1451 ---
1452 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
1453
1454 +++
1455 ** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
1456 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
1457 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
1458
1459 ---
1460 ** F90 mode has new navigation commands `f90-end-of-block',
1461 `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block', `f90-previous-block'.
1462
1463 ---
1464 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
1465 to support use of font-lock.
1466
1467 +++
1468 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
1469 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
1470 `same-window'.
1471
1472 +++
1473 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
1474 `${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
1475 include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
1476
1477 +++
1478 ** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
1479 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
1480 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
1481 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
1482 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
1483 candidate is a directory.
1484
1485 +++
1486 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
1487 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
1488 it remains unchanged.
1489
1490 +++
1491 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
1492 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
1493 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
1494
1495 ** Compilation mode enhancements:
1496
1497 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1498 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1499 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1500 subprocesses inherit.
1501
1502 *** `next-error' now temporarily highlights the corresponding source line.
1503
1504 ** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1505
1506 *** Grep commands now have their own submenu and customization group.
1507
1508 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1509 `grep-scroll-output' can be used to override the corresponding
1510 compilation mode settings for grep commands.
1511
1512 *** Source line is temporarily highlighted when going to next match.
1513
1514 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1515 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1516 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1517 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1518 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1519 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1520 file.
1521
1522 ---
1523 ** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
1524
1525 ---
1526 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
1527 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
1528 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
1529
1530 ---
1531 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
1532 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
1533
1534 ---
1535 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
1536 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
1537 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
1538 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
1539 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
1540 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
1541 against.
1542
1543 ---
1544 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
1545 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
1546 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
1547 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
1548 sound support for those formats.
1549
1550 ---
1551 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
1552 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
1553
1554 ---
1555 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
1556 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
1557 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
1558 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
1559
1560 ---
1561 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
1562 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in
1563 much the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now
1564 adds these colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu
1565 for the default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground),
1566 and uses some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
1567 `list-colors-display' will show the list of System color names if you
1568 wish to use them in other faces.
1569
1570 +++
1571 ** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1572 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1573 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1574 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1575 Meta and Alt:
1576 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1577 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1578
1579 +++
1580 ** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
1581
1582 In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
1583 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
1584 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
1585
1586 P: annotates the previous revision
1587 N: annotates the next revision
1588 J: annotates the revision at line
1589 A: annotates the revision previous to line
1590 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
1591 L: shows the log of the revision at line
1592 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
1593 \f
1594 * New modes and packages in 21.4
1595
1596 +++
1597 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1598 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1599
1600 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1601
1602 ---
1603 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1604
1605 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1606 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1607 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1608 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1609
1610 ---
1611 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1612
1613 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1614 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1615 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1616 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1617 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1618 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1619
1620 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1621 rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1622 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1623 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1624
1625 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1626 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1627 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1628 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1629 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1630 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1631 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1632
1633 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1634 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1635 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1636
1637 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1638 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1639
1640 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1641 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1642 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1643 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1644
1645 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1646 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1647 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
1648 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1649
1650 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1651 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1652 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1653 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1654
1655 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1656 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1657 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1658 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1659 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1660
1661 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1662 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1663 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1664 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1665 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1666 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1667
1668 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1669 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1670 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1671 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1672 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1673 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1674 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1675 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1676 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1677 or local keymaps.
1678
1679 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1680 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1681
1682 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1683 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1684 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1685 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1686
1687 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1688 defined macros.
1689
1690 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1691 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1692 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1693 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1694 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1695 for more commands.
1696
1697 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1698 the keyboard macro ring.
1699
1700 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1701 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1702
1703 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1704 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1705 this behaviour via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1706 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1707
1708 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1709 C-x C-k SPC will step through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1710 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1711
1712 ---
1713 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
1714 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
1715 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
1716 C-c C-i b, and so on.
1717
1718 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1719
1720 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1721 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1722 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1723 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1724 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1725 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1726
1727 +++
1728 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1729
1730 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1731 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1732 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1733 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1734
1735 +++
1736 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1737
1738 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1739 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1740 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1741 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1742 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1743 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1744 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1745 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1746 `rsync' to do the copying).
1747
1748 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1749 `su' and `sudo'.
1750
1751 ---
1752 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1753 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1754 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1755 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1756 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
1757 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1758
1759 ---
1760 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1761 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1762 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1763 settings.
1764
1765 ---
1766 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1767 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1768 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1769 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1770
1771 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1772
1773 ---
1774 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1775 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1776
1777 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1778 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1779 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1780 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1781 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1782 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1783
1784 +++
1785 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1786 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1787 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1788 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1789
1790 ---
1791 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
1792 Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
1793 to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
1794 mode-lines in inverse-video.
1795
1796 ---
1797 ** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
1798
1799 ** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
1800 timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
1801
1802 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
1803 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
1804 in Indented-Text mode.
1805
1806 ** If you set `query-replace-skip-read-only' non-nil,
1807 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
1808 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
1809
1810 ** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the apperance of fringes.
1811
1812 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1813 configuration files.
1814 \f
1815 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.4
1816
1817 ** New function 'define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to change the
1818 built-in fringe bitmaps, as well as create new fringe bitmaps.
1819 The return value is a number identifying the new fringe bitmap.
1820
1821 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and identify the
1822 bitmap to change with the value of the corresponding symbol, like
1823 `left-truncation-fringe-bitmap' or `continued-line-fringe-bitmap'.
1824
1825 ** New function 'destroy-fringe-bitmap' may be used to destroy a
1826 previously created bitmap, or restore a built-in bitmap.
1827
1828 ** New function 'set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
1829 specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. Normally,
1830 this should be a face derived from the `fringe' face, specifying
1831 the foreground color as the desired color of the bitmap.
1832
1833 ** There are new display properties, left-fringe and right-fringe,
1834 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
1835 bitmap of the display line.
1836
1837 Format is 'display '(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE]), where BITMAP is a
1838 number identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or as returned by
1839 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
1840 for displaying the bitmap.
1841
1842 ** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns a cons (LEFT . RIGHT)
1843 identifying the current fringe bitmaps in the display line at a given
1844 buffer position. A nil value means no bitmap.
1845
1846 +++
1847 ** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns line number of current
1848 line in current buffer, or if optional buffer position is given, line
1849 number of corresponding line in current buffer.
1850
1851 ** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
1852 variable `sentence-end-without-space' which contains such characters
1853 that end a sentence without following spaces.
1854
1855 +++
1856 ** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
1857 `format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
1858 implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
1859
1860 +++
1861 ** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal' duplicates
1862 from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element in the list,
1863 the last one is kept.
1864
1865 +++
1866 ** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
1867 documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
1868
1869 ** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
1870 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
1871 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
1872 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
1873
1874 ** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
1875 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
1876 string. The old behavior is available if you call
1877 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
1878
1879 ** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
1880 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
1881 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
1882 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
1883 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
1884
1885 ** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
1886 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
1887 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
1888 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
1889 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
1890
1891 ** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
1892 :pointer image property.
1893
1894 ** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images may now be
1895 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
1896
1897 ** Images may now have an associated image map via the :map property.
1898
1899 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
1900 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
1901 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
1902 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
1903 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
1904 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
1905 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
1906 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
1907
1908 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
1909 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
1910 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
1911 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
1912 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
1913 for possible pointer shapes.
1914
1915 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
1916 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
1917 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
1918
1919 ** Mouse event enhancements:
1920
1921 *** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
1922 events, rather than a text area click event.
1923
1924 *** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
1925 sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
1926 corresponding text row.
1927
1928 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
1929
1930 +++
1931 *** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
1932
1933 +++
1934 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
1935
1936 +++
1937 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
1938 text area).
1939
1940 +++
1941 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
1942
1943 +++
1944 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
1945
1946 +++
1947 *** Mouse events may now include image object in addition to string object.
1948
1949 +++
1950 *** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
1951 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
1952
1953 +++
1954 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
1955 (image or character) clicked on.
1956
1957 +++
1958 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
1959 'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
1960 click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
1961 of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
1962
1963 ** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
1964 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
1965 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
1966 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
1967 forcing an explicit window update.
1968
1969 ** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
1970 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
1971
1972 +++
1973 ** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
1974 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
1975 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
1976 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
1977 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
1978
1979 +++
1980 ** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
1981
1982 +++
1983 ** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
1984 new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
1985 beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
1986 documented.
1987
1988 ** Major modes can define `eldoc-print-current-symbol-info-function'
1989 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
1990 the language.
1991
1992 ---
1993 ** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
1994 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
1995 parts, e.g. utf-16.
1996
1997 +++
1998 ** The argument to forward-word, backward-word, forward-to-indentation
1999 and backward-to-indentation is now optional, and defaults to 1.
2000
2001 +++
2002 ** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
2003 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
2004 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
2005
2006 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
2007 does that, this value may not be accurate.
2008
2009 +++
2010 ** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
2011 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
2012 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
2013 the mode line.
2014
2015 +++
2016 ** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
2017 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
2018
2019 +++
2020 ** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
2021
2022 +++
2023 ** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
2024 `switch-to-buffer'.
2025
2026 +++
2027 ** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
2028 selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
2029
2030 +++
2031 ** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
2032 text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
2033 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
2034
2035 +++
2036 ** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
2037 in the keymap.
2038
2039 ---
2040 ** VC changes for backends:
2041 *** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
2042 *** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
2043 parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
2044 Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
2045 uses the old `destfile' parameter.
2046
2047 +++
2048 ** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
2049 as a dynamic completion table.
2050
2051 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
2052
2053 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
2054 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
2055 completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
2056 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
2057 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
2058 entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
2059
2060 +++
2061 ** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
2062 as a lazy completion table.
2063
2064 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
2065
2066 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
2067 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
2068 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
2069 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
2070 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
2071 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
2072
2073 +++
2074 ** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
2075
2076 +++
2077 ** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
2078 for all (existing and future) frames.
2079
2080 +++
2081 ** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
2082
2083 +++
2084 ** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
2085
2086 +++
2087 ** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
2088
2089 +++
2090 ** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
2091 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
2092 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
2093 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
2094 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
2095
2096 +++
2097 ** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
2098 numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
2099 By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
2100 as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
2101
2102 +++
2103 ** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
2104 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
2105 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
2106 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
2107
2108 ---
2109 ** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
2110 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
2111
2112 +++
2113 ** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
2114 unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
2115 in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
2116 In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
2117
2118 +++
2119 ** New function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the multibyteness
2120 of a string given to a process's filter.
2121
2122 +++
2123 ** New function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if
2124 a string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
2125
2126 +++
2127 ** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string if
2128 the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by the
2129 value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
2130 created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
2131
2132 +++
2133 ** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
2134 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
2135 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
2136 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
2137 which was not compatible with the behaviour of file reading.
2138
2139 +++
2140 ** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
2141 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
2142
2143 +++
2144 ** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
2145 on garbage collection.
2146
2147 +++
2148 ** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
2149 it is read from a file without decoding.
2150
2151 +++
2152 ** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
2153
2154 +++
2155 ** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
2156 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
2157 by calling `select-window'.
2158
2159 ---
2160 ** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
2161 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
2162 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
2163 need to have a name.
2164
2165 ** Byte compiler changes:
2166
2167 ---
2168 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
2169 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
2170 Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
2171 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
2172 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
2173 you anything.
2174
2175 +++
2176 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
2177 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
2178 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
2179 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
2180 forms:
2181
2182 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
2183 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
2184
2185 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
2186 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
2187 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
2188 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
2189 macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
2190 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
2191
2192 +++
2193 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
2194 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
2195
2196 +++
2197 ** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
2198 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
2199 be inserted is translated through it.
2200
2201 +++
2202 ** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
2203 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
2204 current file redefined it).
2205
2206 +++
2207 ** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
2208 whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
2209 instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
2210 testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
2211 show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
2212 a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
2213
2214 *** Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely evaluated;
2215 a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same value. The red
2216 splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly complete their evaluation,
2217 such as `error'. The brown splotches are skipped for forms that are expected
2218 to always evaluate to the same value, such as (setq x 14).
2219
2220 *** For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to help
2221 out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a red splotch.
2222 It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does return. The macro 1value
2223 suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. This macro is a no-op except
2224 during test-coverage -- then it signals an error if the argument actually
2225 returns differing values.
2226
2227 +++
2228 ** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
2229 do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
2230 unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
2231
2232 +++
2233 ** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
2234 that successive calls to print functions should use the same
2235 numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
2236 when `print-circle' is non-nil.
2237
2238 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
2239 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
2240
2241 +++
2242 ** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
2243 the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
2244
2245 +++
2246 ** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
2247 is a copy of a given abbrev table.
2248
2249 +++
2250 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
2251 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
2252 can start with this line:
2253
2254 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
2255
2256 +++
2257 ** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
2258 its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
2259
2260 ---
2261 ** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
2262 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
2263
2264 +++
2265 ** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional buffer
2266 argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted it defaults to
2267 the current buffer.
2268
2269 +++
2270 ** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
2271 and `display-warning'.
2272
2273 +++
2274 ** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
2275 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
2276 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
2277 exported to Lisp.
2278
2279 ---
2280 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
2281 much pure storage it will approximately need.
2282
2283 +++
2284 ** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
2285 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
2286 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
2287 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
2288
2289 ---
2290 ** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
2291 of one coding system from another coding system.
2292
2293 ---
2294 ** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
2295 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
2296 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
2297 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
2298 needed.
2299
2300 ---
2301 ** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
2302 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
2303 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
2304 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
2305 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
2306 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
2307
2308 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
2309 confirmation as before.
2310
2311 +++
2312 ** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
2313
2314 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
2315 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
2316 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
2317 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
2318
2319 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
2320 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
2321 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
2322 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
2323 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
2324 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
2325
2326 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
2327 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
2328 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
2329 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
2330
2331 +++
2332 ** Per-window fringes settings
2333
2334 Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and position
2335 settings.
2336
2337 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
2338 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
2339 `set-window-fringes'.
2340
2341 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
2342 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
2343 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
2344 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
2345
2346 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
2347 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
2348 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
2349 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
2350 an update of the display margins.
2351
2352 +++
2353 ** Per-window vertical scroll-bar settings
2354
2355 Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
2356 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
2357
2358 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
2359 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
2360 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
2361 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
2362 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
2363 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
2364 of the display margins.
2365
2366 +++
2367 ** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
2368 KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
2369 and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
2370
2371 +++
2372 ** Renamed file hooks to follow the convention:
2373 find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
2374 find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
2375 write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
2376 write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions.
2377 Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
2378
2379 +++
2380 ** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
2381 It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
2382 name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2383
2384 +++
2385 ** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
2386 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
2387 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
2388 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
2389 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
2390
2391 ---
2392 ** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
2393 to override the internal read-file-name function.
2394
2395 +++
2396 ** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
2397 `read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
2398 will only show directories.
2399
2400 +++
2401 ** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
2402 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
2403 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
2404
2405 ---
2406 ** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
2407 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
2408 (require 'cl) when loaded.
2409
2410 +++
2411 ** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
2412 indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
2413 syntax of defmacro has been extended to
2414
2415 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
2416
2417 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
2418 declaration specifiers supported are:
2419
2420 (indent INDENT)
2421 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
2422
2423 (edebug DEBUG)
2424 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
2425 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
2426
2427 +++
2428 ** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
2429
2430 This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
2431 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
2432 binding and lookup functionality.
2433
2434 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
2435 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
2436 original command.
2437
2438 Example:
2439 Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
2440 my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
2441 bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
2442 kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
2443 kill-word.
2444
2445 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
2446 command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
2447 my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
2448 map using define-key:
2449
2450 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
2451 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
2452
2453 Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
2454 the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
2455
2456 Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
2457 example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
2458 then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
2459
2460 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
2461
2462 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
2463 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
2464 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
2465 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
2466
2467 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
2468 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
2469
2470 - key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
2471 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
2472
2473 - where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
2474 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
2475 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
2476 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
2477 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
2478 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
2479
2480 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
2481 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
2482 command was not remapped.
2483
2484 +++
2485 ** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
2486
2487 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
2488 keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
2489 alist to this list.
2490
2491 +++
2492 ** Atomic change groups.
2493
2494 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
2495 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
2496 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
2497
2498 (atomic-change-group
2499 (insert foo)
2500 (delete-region x y))
2501
2502 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
2503 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
2504 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
2505 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
2506
2507 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
2508 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
2509
2510 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
2511 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
2512 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
2513 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
2514
2515 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
2516 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
2517 do this.
2518
2519 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
2520 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
2521 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
2522 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
2523
2524 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
2525 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
2526 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
2527 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
2528 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
2529 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
2530 twice.
2531
2532 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
2533 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
2534 returned values, like this:
2535
2536 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
2537 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
2538
2539 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
2540 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
2541 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
2542
2543 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
2544 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
2545 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
2546 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
2547 finished.
2548
2549 +++
2550 ** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
2551
2552 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
2553 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
2554 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
2555 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
2556
2557 +++
2558 ** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
2559
2560 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
2561 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
2562 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
2563 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
2564
2565 +++
2566 ** New function remove-list-of-text-properties.
2567
2568 The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties' is almost the same
2569 as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes
2570 a list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
2571
2572 +++
2573 ** New function insert-for-yank.
2574
2575 This function normally works like `insert' but removes the text
2576 properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list. However, if the
2577 inserted text has a `yank-handler' text property on the first
2578 character of the string, the insertion of the text may be modified in
2579 a number of ways. See the description of `yank-handler' below.
2580
2581 +++
2582 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank.
2583
2584 This function works like `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the
2585 text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
2586
2587 +++
2588 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
2589
2590 This function is like insert-buffer-substring, but removes all
2591 text properties from the inserted substring.
2592
2593 +++
2594 ** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
2595 previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
2596
2597 The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
2598 elements with the following format:
2599 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
2600
2601 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
2602 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
2603 element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
2604 the normal behaviour of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
2605
2606 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
2607 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
2608 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
2609 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
2610 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
2611 rectangle.
2612 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
2613 yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
2614 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
2615 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
2616 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
2617 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
2618 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
2619 FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
2620
2621 *** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
2622 optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
2623 the killed text.
2624
2625 *** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
2626 `yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
2627 yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
2628 insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
2629 element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
2630
2631 +++
2632 ** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
2633 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
2634
2635 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
2636 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
2637 defined with defface.
2638
2639 +++
2640 ** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
2641 accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
2642 inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
2643
2644 +++
2645 ** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
2646 help with handling relative face attributes.
2647
2648 +++
2649 ** Enhancements to process support
2650
2651 *** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
2652 only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
2653
2654 *** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
2655 functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
2656 supported, but new code should use the new functions.
2657
2658 *** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
2659 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
2660
2661 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
2662 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
2663
2664 The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
2665 and modify elements on this property list.
2666
2667 The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
2668 used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
2669
2670 ???
2671 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
2672
2673 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
2674 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
2675 very poor performance. This behaviour can be remedied to some extent
2676 by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
2677 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
2678 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
2679 emacs tries to read it.
2680
2681 +++
2682 ** Enhanced networking support.
2683
2684 *** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
2685 opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
2686 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
2687
2688 - A server is started using :server t arg.
2689 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
2690 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
2691 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
2692 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
2693 - The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
2694 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
2695 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
2696
2697 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
2698 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
2699
2700 *** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
2701
2702 *** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
2703
2704 This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
2705 without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
2706 filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
2707 connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
2708 matching "open" or "failed".
2709
2710 *** New function open-network-stream-server.
2711
2712 This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
2713 When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
2714 is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
2715 is called for the new process.
2716
2717 *** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
2718
2719 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
2720 and set the current address of the remote partner.
2721
2722 *** New function format-network-address.
2723
2724 This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
2725 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
2726 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
2727 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
2728 string for other formatting options.
2729
2730 *** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
2731 for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
2732 of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
2733
2734 Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
2735 remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
2736 element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
2737 the fifth is the port number.
2738
2739 *** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
2740 `stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
2741 connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
2742 no input is received in the stopped state.
2743
2744 *** New function network-interface-list.
2745
2746 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
2747 current network addresses.
2748
2749 *** New function network-interface-info.
2750
2751 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
2752 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
2753
2754 +++
2755 ** New function copy-tree.
2756
2757 +++
2758 ** New function substring-no-properties.
2759
2760 +++
2761 ** New function minibuffer-selected-window.
2762
2763 +++
2764 ** New function `call-process-shell-command'.
2765
2766 ---
2767 ** The dummy function keys made by easymenu
2768 are now always lower case. If you specify the
2769 menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
2770 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
2771
2772 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for
2773 the bindings that were made with easymenu.
2774
2775 +++
2776 ** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
2777 argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
2778 for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
2779 and does not return t for keyboard macros.
2780
2781 ---
2782 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
2783 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
2784
2785 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
2786 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
2787 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
2788 commands.
2789
2790 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
2791 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
2792 SQL buffer.
2793
2794 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
2795 (function (lambda ()
2796 (master-mode t)
2797 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
2798 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
2799 (function (lambda ()
2800 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
2801
2802 +++
2803 ** File local variables.
2804
2805 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
2806 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
2807
2808 +++
2809 ** New function window-body-height.
2810
2811 This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
2812 or the header line.
2813
2814 +++
2815 ** New function format-mode-line.
2816
2817 This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
2818 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
2819
2820 +++
2821 ** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
2822
2823 These functions are like `plist-get' and `plist-put' except that they
2824 compare the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
2825
2826 +++
2827 ** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
2828
2829 The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
2830 recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
2831 Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
2832 you specify the map to use as an argument.
2833
2834 +++
2835 ** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
2836
2837 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
2838 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
2839 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
2840
2841 +++
2842 ** You can now make a window as short as one line.
2843
2844 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
2845 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
2846 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
2847 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
2848 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
2849
2850 +++
2851 ** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
2852 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
2853 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
2854 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
2855
2856 +++
2857 ** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
2858 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
2859
2860 +++
2861 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
2862 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
2863 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
2864
2865 +++
2866 ** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
2867 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
2868 line.
2869
2870 ---
2871 ** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
2872 cl-indent package. The new user options
2873 `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
2874 `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
2875 indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
2876
2877 ---
2878 ** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
2879 cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
2880
2881 +++
2882 ** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
2883
2884 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
2885 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
2886 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
2887 now:
2888
2889 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
2890
2891 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
2892 the time it takes to convert the format.
2893
2894 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
2895 wasteful.
2896
2897 +++
2898 ** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
2899 over minor mode keymaps.
2900
2901 +++
2902 ** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
2903 An octal escape makes it unibyte.
2904
2905 +++
2906 ** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
2907 text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
2908 image or composition property.
2909
2910 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
2911 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
2912 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
2913 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
2914 post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
2915
2916 +++
2917 ** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
2918 argument, LIMIT.
2919
2920 +++
2921 ** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
2922 non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
2923 it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
2924 Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
2925 flag.
2926
2927 ---
2928 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
2929
2930 ---
2931 ** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
2932
2933 ---
2934 ** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
2935 Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
2936 find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
2937 that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
2938 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
2939 In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
2940
2941 ---
2942 ** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
2943 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
2944 bindings of the parent keymap.
2945
2946 ---
2947 ** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
2948 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
2949 (see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
2950 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
2951 depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
2952 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
2953
2954 s{
2955 foo
2956 }{
2957 bar
2958 }e
2959
2960 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
2961 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
2962 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
2963 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
2964
2965 ---
2966 ** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
2967 called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
2968
2969 ** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
2970 (the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
2971
2972 +++
2973 ** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
2974 it receives a request from emacsclient.
2975
2976 ---
2977 ** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
2978 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
2979 than 3 levels of nesting.
2980
2981 ---
2982 ** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
2983 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
2984 it in that buffer.
2985
2986 ---
2987 ** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
2988 properties from surrounding text.
2989
2990 +++
2991 ** New function `buffer-local-value'.
2992
2993 This function returns the buffer-local binding of VARIABLE (a symbol)
2994 in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not have a buffer-local binding in
2995 buffer BUFFER, it returns the default value of VARIABLE instead.
2996
2997 ---
2998 ** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
2999 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3000 clone to the other.
3001
3002 +++
3003 ** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
3004 *** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
3005 of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
3006 other properties than `face'.
3007 *** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
3008 properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
3009
3010 ---
3011 ** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
3012 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
3013 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
3014 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
3015 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
3016
3017 +++
3018 ** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
3019 are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
3020 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
3021
3022 +++
3023 ** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
3024 and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
3025
3026 +++
3027 ** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
3028 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
3029
3030 +++
3031 ** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
3032 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
3033 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
3034
3035 +++
3036 ** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3037 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3038 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3039
3040 +++
3041 ** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
3042 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
3043 accepts a float as UID parameter.
3044
3045 ---
3046 ** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3047
3048 +++
3049 ** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
3050
3051 +++
3052 ** The Emacs Lisp byte-compiler now displays the actual line and
3053 character position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form
3054 of its warning and error messages have been brought more in line with
3055 the output of other GNU tools.
3056
3057 +++
3058 ** New functions `keymap-prompt' and `current-active-maps'.
3059
3060 ---
3061 ** New function `describe-buffer-bindings'.
3062
3063 +++
3064 ** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3065 searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
3066
3067 +++
3068 ** Variable aliases have been implemented:
3069
3070 *** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3071
3072 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3073 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3074 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3075 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3076
3077 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3078 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3079
3080 *** indirect-variable VARIABLE
3081
3082 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3083 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3084 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3085
3086 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3087 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3088
3089 +++
3090 ** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
3091 collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
3092
3093 +++
3094 ** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
3095 the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
3096
3097 +++
3098 ** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
3099 hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3100
3101 ---
3102 ** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
3103 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
3104 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
3105
3106 ** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
3107 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3108 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3109
3110 ** New function x-send-client-message sends a client message when
3111 running under X.
3112
3113 ** New packages:
3114
3115 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
3116 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
3117 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
3118 state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
3119 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
3120 Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
3121
3122 Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
3123
3124 *** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
3125 current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
3126
3127 *** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
3128 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
3129 data structures.
3130
3131 *** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
3132 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
3133
3134 *** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
3135 in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
3136 implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
3137 require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
3138 as help and apropos buffers.
3139
3140 \f
3141 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
3142
3143 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
3144 been added.
3145
3146 \f
3147 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
3148
3149 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
3150 with Custom.
3151
3152 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
3153 as mule-utf-8. Coding system `utf-16-le-dos' is useful as the value
3154 of `selection-coding-system' in MS Windows, allowing you to paste
3155 multilingual text from the clipboard. Set it interactively with
3156 C-x RET x or in .emacs with `(set-selection-coding-system 'utf-16-le-dos)'.
3157
3158 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
3159 in UTF-8 locales).
3160
3161 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
3162 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
3163 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
3164 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
3165 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
3166 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
3167 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
3168 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
3169 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
3170 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
3171
3172 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
3173 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
3174
3175 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
3176 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
3177 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
3178 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behaviour is actually
3179 contrary to the compound text specification.
3180
3181 \f
3182 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
3183
3184 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
3185
3186 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
3187
3188 \f
3189 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
3190
3191 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
3192
3193 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
3194 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
3195 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
3196 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
3197 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
3198
3199 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
3200 were changed.
3201
3202 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
3203 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
3204
3205 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
3206 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
3207 instead of using default-major-mode.
3208
3209 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
3210 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
3211 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
3212 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
3213 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
3214 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
3215 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
3216
3217 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
3218 NEWS.
3219
3220 \f
3221 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
3222
3223 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
3224 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
3225 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
3226
3227 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
3228 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
3229
3230 \f
3231 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
3232
3233 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
3234 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
3235 charsets in this release.
3236
3237 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
3238
3239 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
3240
3241 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
3242 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
3243 to list them.
3244
3245 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
3246 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
3247 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
3248 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
3249 necessary changes to unexec.
3250
3251 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
3252 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
3253
3254 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
3255 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
3256
3257 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
3258 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
3259
3260 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
3261 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
3262 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
3263 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
3264 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
3265
3266 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
3267 new display features described below.
3268
3269 \f
3270 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
3271
3272 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
3273
3274 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
3275 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
3276 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
3277 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
3278 the text.
3279
3280 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
3281
3282 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
3283 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
3284 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
3285 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
3286 specify a font.
3287
3288 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
3289 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
3290 under Lisp changes, below.
3291
3292 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
3293
3294 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
3295 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
3296 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
3297 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
3298 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
3299 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
3300 on terminals.
3301
3302 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
3303 supported on character terminals.
3304
3305 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
3306 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
3307 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
3308 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
3309
3310 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
3311
3312 ** Sound support
3313
3314 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
3315 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
3316 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
3317 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
3318 sound support.
3319
3320 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
3321
3322 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
3323 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
3324 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
3325 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
3326
3327 - User option: max-mini-window-height
3328
3329 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
3330 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
3331 specifies a number of lines.
3332
3333 Default is 0.25.
3334
3335 - User option: resize-mini-windows
3336
3337 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
3338 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
3339 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
3340 again.
3341
3342 Default is `grow-only'.
3343
3344 ** LessTif support.
3345
3346 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
3347 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
3348
3349 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
3350
3351 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
3352 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
3353 non-nil.
3354
3355 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
3356
3357 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
3358 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
3359 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
3360
3361 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
3362
3363 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
3364 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
3365 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
3366 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
3367 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
3368 Emacs.
3369
3370 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
3371 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
3372 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
3373 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
3374 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
3375 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
3376
3377 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
3378 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
3379 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
3380 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
3381 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
3382 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
3383
3384 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
3385 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
3386 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
3387 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
3388 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
3389
3390 ** Tool bar support.
3391
3392 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
3393 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
3394 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
3395 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
3396 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
3397 icons will be used.
3398
3399 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
3400 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
3401
3402 ** Tooltips.
3403
3404 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
3405 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
3406 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
3407
3408 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
3409 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
3410 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
3411 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
3412
3413 ** Automatic Hscrolling
3414
3415 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
3416 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
3417 customized.
3418
3419 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
3420 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
3421 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
3422 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
3423 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
3424
3425 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
3426 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
3427 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
3428 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
3429 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
3430 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
3431
3432 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
3433 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
3434 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
3435 customizing face `fringe'.
3436
3437 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
3438 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
3439 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
3440 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
3441 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
3442 the window to be partially obscured.)
3443
3444 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
3445 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
3446 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
3447 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
3448
3449 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
3450
3451 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
3452 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
3453 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
3454 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
3455 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
3456 have enabled one.
3457
3458 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
3459
3460 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
3461
3462 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
3463
3464 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
3465 `*') toggles the status.
3466
3467 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
3468
3469 ** Hourglass pointer
3470
3471 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
3472 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
3473
3474 ** Blinking cursor
3475
3476 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
3477 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
3478 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
3479 the group `cursor'.
3480
3481 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
3482
3483 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
3484 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
3485 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
3486 details.
3487
3488 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
3489 have to do anything to activate it.
3490
3491 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
3492
3493 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
3494 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
3495
3496 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
3497 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
3498 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
3499 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
3500 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
3501 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
3502 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
3503 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
3504
3505 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
3506 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
3507 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
3508 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
3509 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
3510 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
3511
3512 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
3513 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
3514
3515 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
3516 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
3517 buffer by default.
3518
3519 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
3520 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
3521 beginning and end of the buffer.
3522
3523 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
3524 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
3525 signaled.
3526
3527 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
3528 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
3529
3530 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
3531 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
3532 this behavior.
3533
3534 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
3535 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
3536 Emacs dump core.
3537
3538 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
3539
3540 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
3541 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
3542 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
3543
3544 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
3545 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
3546 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
3547
3548 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
3549 using that menu.
3550
3551 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
3552
3553 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
3554 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
3555 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
3556 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
3557 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
3558 whitespace.
3559
3560 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
3561 all frames except the selected one.
3562
3563 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
3564 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
3565
3566 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
3567 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
3568 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
3569 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
3570 `Info-use-header-line'.
3571
3572 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
3573 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
3574 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
3575
3576 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
3577
3578 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
3579 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
3580 `fr-drdref.tex'.
3581
3582 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
3583 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
3584 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
3585 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
3586
3587 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
3588
3589 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
3590 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
3591 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
3592 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
3593
3594 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
3595 point in a pop-up window.
3596
3597 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
3598 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
3599 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
3600
3601 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
3602 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
3603
3604 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
3605 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
3606 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
3607 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
3608
3609 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
3610
3611 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
3612 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
3613
3614 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
3615 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
3616 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
3617
3618 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
3619 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
3620 non-nil.
3621
3622 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
3623 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
3624 file that is already visited under a different name.
3625
3626 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
3627 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
3628
3629 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
3630 and displays information about that.
3631
3632 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
3633 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
3634
3635 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
3636 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
3637 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
3638 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
3639 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
3640 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
3641
3642 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
3643 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
3644
3645 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
3646 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
3647 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
3648 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
3649 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
3650 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
3651 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
3652
3653 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
3654 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
3655
3656 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
3657 system for keyboard input.
3658
3659 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
3660 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
3661 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
3662 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
3663 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
3664 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
3665 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
3666 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
3667 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
3668
3669 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
3670 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
3671
3672 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
3673 displays all characters in that character set.
3674
3675 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
3676 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
3677
3678 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
3679 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
3680 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
3681
3682 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
3683 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
3684 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
3685 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
3686 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
3687 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
3688 and Polish `slash'.
3689
3690 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
3691 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
3692 of the tutorial.
3693
3694 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
3695 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
3696 Lisp Coding Convention".
3697
3698 new command old-binding
3699 --- ------- -----------
3700 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
3701 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
3702 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
3703
3704 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
3705 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
3706 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
3707
3708 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
3709 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
3710 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
3711 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
3712 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
3713 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
3714
3715 ** There are new Leim input methods.
3716 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
3717 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
3718 package.
3719
3720 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
3721 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
3722 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
3723 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
3724 "`", you must type "=q".
3725
3726 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
3727 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
3728 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
3729 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
3730 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
3731 on.
3732
3733 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
3734 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
3735 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
3736 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
3737
3738 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
3739 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
3740 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
3741 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
3742
3743 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
3744 on the display using several methods
3745
3746 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
3747 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
3748 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
3749
3750 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
3751 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
3752
3753 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
3754
3755 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
3756 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
3757
3758 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
3759 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
3760 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
3761 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
3762
3763 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
3764 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
3765 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
3766
3767 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
3768 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
3769
3770 ** New X resources recognized
3771
3772 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
3773 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
3774 is useful for debugging X problems.
3775
3776 Example:
3777
3778 emacs.synchronous: true
3779
3780 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
3781 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
3782 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
3783 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
3784 visual class names are
3785
3786 TrueColor
3787 PseudoColor
3788 DirectColor
3789 StaticColor
3790 GrayScale
3791 StaticGray
3792
3793 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
3794 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
3795 meaning.
3796
3797 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
3798 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
3799 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
3800 visual.
3801
3802 Example:
3803
3804 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
3805
3806 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
3807 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
3808 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
3809 resource values are `true' or `on'.
3810
3811 Example:
3812
3813 emacs.privateColormap: true
3814
3815 ** Faces and frame parameters.
3816
3817 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
3818 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
3819 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
3820 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
3821 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
3822 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
3823 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
3824
3825 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
3826 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
3827 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
3828 `default' face and vice versa.
3829
3830 ** New face `menu'.
3831
3832 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
3833
3834 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
3835
3836 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
3837 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
3838 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
3839 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
3840
3841 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
3842 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
3843 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
3844
3845 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
3846 `ScreenGamma'.
3847
3848 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
3849
3850 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
3851 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
3852 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
3853 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
3854
3855 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
3856
3857 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
3858
3859 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
3860
3861 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
3862 LessTif/Motif one.
3863
3864 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
3865 LessTif and Motif.
3866
3867 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
3868
3869 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
3870 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
3871 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
3872
3873 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
3874 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
3875
3876 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
3877 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
3878 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
3879
3880 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
3881
3882 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
3883 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
3884 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
3885 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
3886
3887 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
3888 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
3889 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
3890 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
3891
3892 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
3893 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
3894 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
3895 buffers.
3896
3897 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
3898
3899 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
3900 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
3901 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
3902
3903 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
3904 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
3905 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
3906 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
3907 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
3908 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
3909
3910 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
3911
3912 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
3913 notably at the end of lines.
3914
3915 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
3916 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
3917
3918 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
3919
3920 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
3921 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
3922
3923 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
3924 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
3925 after each match to get the replacement text.
3926
3927 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
3928 you edit the replacement string.
3929
3930 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
3931 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
3932 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
3933
3934 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
3935
3936 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
3937 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
3938
3939 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
3940 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
3941 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
3942 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
3943
3944 --
3945 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
3946 read mail from the menu etc.
3947
3948 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
3949 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
3950 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
3951 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
3952
3953 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
3954 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
3955
3956 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
3957 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
3958 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
3959 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
3960 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
3961 of Emacs.
3962
3963 ** Customize changes
3964
3965 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
3966 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
3967 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
3968 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
3969 earlier versions of Emacs.
3970
3971 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
3972 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
3973 default).
3974
3975 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
3976 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
3977 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
3978 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
3979 file.
3980
3981 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
3982 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
3983 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
3984 already in your init file.
3985
3986 ** New features in evaluation commands
3987
3988 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
3989 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
3990 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
3991 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
3992 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
3993
3994 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
3995 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
3996 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
3997 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
3998 printed).
3999
4000 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
4001 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
4002
4003 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
4004 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
4005
4006 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
4007 code when called with a prefix argument.
4008
4009 ** CC mode changes.
4010
4011 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
4012 current user setups (although it's believed that these
4013 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
4014 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
4015 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
4016 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
4017 release.
4018
4019 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
4020 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
4021 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
4022 confusion.
4023
4024 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
4025 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
4026 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
4027 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
4028
4029 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
4030 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
4031
4032 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
4033 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
4034
4035 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
4036 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
4037 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
4038 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
4039
4040 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
4041 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
4042 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
4043 earlier statement. An example:
4044
4045 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
4046 if (a[i])
4047 res += a[i]->offset;
4048 else
4049
4050 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
4051 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
4052 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
4053 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
4054 the preceding "if".
4055
4056 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
4057 by default.
4058
4059 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
4060 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
4061 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
4062 documentation or other natural language text.
4063
4064 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
4065 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
4066 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
4067 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
4068 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
4069 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
4070 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
4071
4072 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
4073 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
4074 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
4075 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
4076
4077 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
4078 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
4079 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
4080 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
4081 Pike mode only.
4082
4083 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
4084 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
4085 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
4086 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
4087 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
4088 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
4089 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
4090 is reported afterwards.
4091
4092 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
4093 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
4094 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
4095
4096 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
4097 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
4098 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
4099 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
4100 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
4101 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
4102 groundwork.
4103
4104 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
4105 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
4106 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
4107 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
4108 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
4109 have to bother.
4110
4111 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
4112 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
4113 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
4114 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
4115 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
4116 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
4117
4118 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
4119 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
4120 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
4121 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
4122 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
4123 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
4124 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
4125 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
4126
4127 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
4128 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
4129 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
4130 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
4131 above.
4132
4133 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
4134 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
4135 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
4136 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
4137 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
4138 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
4139 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
4140 function documentation for more info.
4141
4142 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
4143 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
4144 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
4145 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
4146 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
4147 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
4148 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
4149 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
4150
4151 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
4152
4153 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
4154 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
4155
4156 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
4157 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
4158 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
4159 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
4160 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
4161 style system.
4162
4163 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
4164 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
4165 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
4166 as far as possible.
4167
4168 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
4169 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
4170 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
4171 chapter about this in the manual.
4172
4173 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
4174 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
4175 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
4176 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
4177 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
4178
4179 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
4180 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
4181 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
4182
4183 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
4184 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
4185
4186 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
4187 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
4188 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
4189 inside CC Mode.
4190
4191 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
4192 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
4193 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
4194 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
4195 cc-mode/).
4196
4197 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
4198 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
4199 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
4200 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
4201 they were before the filling.
4202
4203 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
4204 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
4205 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
4206 literals.
4207
4208 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
4209 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
4210 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
4211 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
4212 this function.
4213
4214 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
4215 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
4216 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
4217 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
4218 Thanks to Eric Eide.
4219
4220 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
4221 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
4222 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
4223
4224 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
4225
4226 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
4227 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
4228 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
4229 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
4230
4231 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
4232 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
4233 the column specified by comment-column.
4234
4235 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
4236 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
4237 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
4238 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
4239 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
4240 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
4241
4242 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
4243 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
4244 arguments.
4245
4246 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
4247
4248 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
4249 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
4250 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
4251 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
4252 Provan).
4253
4254 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
4255
4256 ** Dired changes
4257
4258 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
4259 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
4260 is, delete only empty directories.
4261
4262 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
4263 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
4264 copy directories recursively.
4265
4266 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
4267 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
4268 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
4269
4270 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
4271 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
4272 directory.
4273
4274 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
4275 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
4276 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
4277 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
4278 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
4279
4280 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
4281 from ls switches.
4282
4283 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
4284 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
4285 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
4286 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
4287
4288 ** Gnus changes.
4289
4290 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
4291 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
4292 internationalization and mail-fetching.
4293
4294 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
4295 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
4296
4297 If you used procmail like in
4298
4299 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
4300 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
4301 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
4302 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
4303
4304 this now has changed to
4305
4306 (setq mail-sources
4307 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
4308 :suffix ".in")))
4309
4310 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
4311 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
4312
4313 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
4314 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
4315 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
4316 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
4317
4318 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
4319 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
4320 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
4321
4322 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
4323 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
4324 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
4325 now just a compatibility layer.
4326
4327 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
4328 Gnus facilities.
4329
4330 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
4331 called to position point.
4332
4333 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
4334 summary buffers and NOV files.
4335
4336 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
4337 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
4338
4339 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
4340 subtly different manner.
4341
4342 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
4343 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
4344 ever-changing layouts.
4345
4346 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
4347
4348 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
4349
4350 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
4351
4352 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
4353 macros
4354
4355 Key binding Macro
4356 -------------------------
4357 C-c C-c C-s @strong
4358 C-c C-c C-e @emph
4359 C-c C-c u @uref
4360 C-c C-c q @quotation
4361 C-c C-c m @email
4362 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
4363 M-RET @item
4364
4365 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
4366
4367 ** Changes in Outline mode.
4368
4369 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
4370 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
4371 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
4372
4373 ** Changes to Emacs Server
4374
4375 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
4376 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
4377 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
4378 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
4379 buffers to kill, as before.
4380
4381 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
4382 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
4383 this way.
4384
4385 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
4386 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
4387
4388 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
4389
4390 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
4391 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
4392 use. Default is 1000.
4393
4394 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
4395 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
4396
4397 ** Changes to hideshow.el
4398
4399 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
4400
4401 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
4402 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
4403 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
4404 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
4405
4406 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
4407 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
4408 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
4409 the open block.
4410
4411 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
4412 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
4413 the normal block-hiding function.
4414
4415 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
4416
4417 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
4418 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
4419 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
4420 for `hs-minor-mode'.
4421
4422 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
4423 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
4424
4425 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
4426
4427 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
4428 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
4429 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
4430
4431 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
4432 current buffer.
4433
4434 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
4435 in a log file.
4436
4437 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
4438 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
4439 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
4440 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
4441 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
4442 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
4443
4444 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
4445
4446 ** Changes to cmuscheme
4447
4448 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
4449 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
4450
4451 ** Changes in Font Lock
4452
4453 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
4454 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
4455
4456 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
4457 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
4458
4459 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
4460 the face used for each string/comment.
4461
4462 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
4463 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
4464
4465 ** Changes to Shell mode
4466
4467 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
4468 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
4469 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
4470 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
4471
4472 ** Comint (subshell) changes
4473
4474 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
4475 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
4476
4477 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
4478 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
4479 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
4480 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
4481 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
4482 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
4483
4484 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
4485 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
4486 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
4487 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
4488 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
4489 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
4490 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
4491 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
4492
4493 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
4494 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
4495
4496 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
4497 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
4498 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
4499
4500 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
4501 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
4502 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
4503
4504 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
4505 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
4506 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
4507
4508 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
4509 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
4510 argument, it appends to the file.
4511
4512 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
4513 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
4514 compatibility.
4515
4516 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
4517 ring (history).
4518
4519 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
4520 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
4521 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
4522
4523 ** Changes to Rmail mode
4524
4525 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
4526 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
4527 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
4528 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
4529 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
4530 as correspondent.
4531
4532 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
4533 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
4534 regexp matching your mail addresses.
4535
4536 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
4537 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
4538 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
4539 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
4540 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
4541
4542 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
4543 like `j'.
4544
4545 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
4546 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
4547 digest message.
4548
4549 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
4550 in which folder to put messages automatically.
4551
4552 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
4553 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
4554 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
4555
4556 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
4557 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
4558
4559 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
4560 use the -f option when sending mail.
4561
4562 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
4563 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
4564 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
4565 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
4566 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
4567 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
4568
4569 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
4570 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
4571 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
4572
4573 ** Changes to TeX mode
4574
4575 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
4576 `latex-mode'.
4577
4578 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
4579
4580 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
4581
4582 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
4583
4584 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
4585
4586 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
4587 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
4588 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
4589 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
4590 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
4591 can be edited from that buffer.
4592
4593 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
4594 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
4595 `A' to use all marked entries).
4596
4597 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
4598 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
4599
4600 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
4601 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
4602 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
4603 been cited.
4604
4605 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
4606 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
4607 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
4608 in column 1 are always made leaves.
4609
4610 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
4611 has the following new features:
4612
4613 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
4614 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
4615 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
4616 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
4617
4618 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
4619 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
4620 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
4621 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
4622 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
4623 defaults to 1.
4624
4625 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
4626 file names.
4627
4628 ** Ispell changes
4629
4630 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
4631 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
4632 spell-checks the current buffer.
4633
4634 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
4635 added.
4636
4637 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
4638 correction is made and re-checked.
4639
4640 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
4641
4642 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
4643 cases.
4644
4645 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
4646 on syntax errors.
4647
4648 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
4649 end of the buffer.
4650
4651 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
4652
4653 ** Makefile mode changes
4654
4655 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
4656
4657 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
4658 Fontlock mode is active.
4659
4660 ** Isearch changes
4661
4662 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
4663 so that searches can be resumed.
4664
4665 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
4666 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
4667 that started the search.
4668
4669 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
4670 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
4671
4672 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
4673
4674 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
4675 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
4676 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
4677 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
4678 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
4679 `secondary-selection'.
4680
4681 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
4682 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
4683 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
4684 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
4685 usual snappy response.
4686
4687 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
4688 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
4689 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
4690 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
4691
4692 ** VC Changes
4693
4694 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
4695 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
4696 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
4697 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
4698 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
4699 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
4700 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
4701 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
4702 file is registered in that backend.
4703
4704 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
4705 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
4706 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
4707 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
4708 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
4709 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
4710
4711 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
4712 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
4713 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
4714 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
4715 where it doesn't make sense.)
4716
4717 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
4718 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
4719 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
4720
4721 *** General Changes
4722
4723 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
4724 checks are always done now.
4725
4726 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
4727 operations.
4728
4729 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
4730 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
4731 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
4732
4733 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
4734 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
4735 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
4736 the working file (``merge news'').
4737
4738 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
4739 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
4740 downwards.
4741
4742 *** Multiple Backends
4743
4744 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
4745 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
4746 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
4747 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
4748 local RCS archives.
4749
4750 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
4751 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
4752 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
4753 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
4754
4755 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
4756 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
4757 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
4758 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
4759 current revision number from the more remote backend.
4760
4761 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
4762 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
4763 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
4764 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
4765
4766 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
4767 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
4768 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
4769 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
4770
4771 *** Changes for CVS
4772
4773 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
4774 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
4775 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
4776 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
4777 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
4778 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
4779 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
4780
4781 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
4782 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
4783 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
4784 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
4785 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
4786 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
4787 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
4788 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
4789 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
4790 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
4791 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
4792 name.)
4793
4794 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
4795 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
4796 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
4797 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
4798 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
4799 entire directory tree.
4800
4801 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
4802 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
4803 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
4804 "watched" by other developers.)
4805
4806 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
4807 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
4808 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
4809 starting at the given directory.
4810
4811 *** Lisp Changes in VC
4812
4813 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
4814 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
4815 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
4816 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
4817 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
4818 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
4819 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
4820 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
4821 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
4822
4823 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
4824 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
4825 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
4826 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
4827
4828 ** New modes and packages
4829
4830 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
4831 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
4832 the default is not applicable.
4833
4834 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
4835 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
4836 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
4837
4838 Features are:
4839
4840 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
4841 drawn, like this: | \ /
4842 --+-- X
4843 | / \
4844
4845 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
4846 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
4847 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
4848 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
4849 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
4850 you are drawing.
4851
4852 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
4853 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
4854
4855 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
4856 flood-filling.
4857
4858 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
4859 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
4860 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
4861 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
4862
4863 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
4864 also do without the mouse.
4865
4866 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
4867 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
4868 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
4869 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
4870 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
4871
4872 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
4873
4874 lines straight-lines
4875 rectangles squares
4876 poly-lines straight poly-lines
4877 ellipses circles
4878 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
4879 spray-can setting size for spraying
4880 vaporize line vaporize lines
4881 erase characters erase rectangles
4882
4883 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
4884 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
4885 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
4886 drawing.
4887
4888 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
4889 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
4890 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
4891 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
4892
4893 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
4894 can be turned off).
4895
4896 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
4897 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
4898 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
4899 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
4900 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
4901 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
4902 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
4903 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
4904 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
4905
4906 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
4907 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
4908 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
4909 on certain projects.
4910
4911 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
4912 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
4913
4914 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
4915
4916 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
4917 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
4918 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
4919 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
4920 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
4921 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
4922 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
4923 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
4924
4925 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
4926 Emacs is idle.
4927
4928 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
4929 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
4930
4931 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
4932 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
4933
4934 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
4935 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
4936 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
4937 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
4938 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
4939
4940 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
4941 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
4942 separate Texinfo file.
4943
4944 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
4945 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
4946 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
4947 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
4948 enter check-in log messages.
4949
4950 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
4951 without invoking external programs.
4952
4953 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
4954 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
4955 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
4956 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
4957 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
4958
4959 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
4960 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
4961
4962 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
4963 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
4964
4965 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
4966 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
4967 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
4968 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
4969 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
4970 single step.
4971
4972 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
4973 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
4974 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
4975 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
4976
4977 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
4978 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
4979 actually modifying content of a buffer.
4980
4981 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
4982 PostScript.
4983
4984 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
4985
4986 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
4987
4988 ; comment (until end of line)
4989 A non-terminal
4990 "C" terminal
4991 ?C? special
4992 $A default non-terminal
4993 $"C" default terminal
4994 $?C? default special
4995 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
4996 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
4997 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
4998 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
4999 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
5000 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
5001 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
5002 C+ one or more occurrences of C
5003 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
5004 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
5005 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
5006 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
5007 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
5008 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
5009 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
5010
5011 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
5012
5013 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
5014 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
5015 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
5016 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
5017 equal signs of assignments.
5018
5019 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
5020 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
5021
5022 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
5023 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
5024 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
5025
5026 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
5027
5028 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
5029 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
5030 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
5031 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
5032 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
5033 which answers different needs.
5034
5035 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
5036 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
5037 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
5038 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
5039 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
5040 to be enabled.
5041
5042 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
5043 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
5044
5045 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
5046
5047 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
5048 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
5049 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
5050
5051 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
5052
5053 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
5054 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
5055 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
5056 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
5057 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
5058 and background colors.
5059
5060 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
5061 Pascal) language.
5062
5063 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
5064 the text at point.
5065
5066 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
5067
5068 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
5069
5070 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
5071 whitespace in a file.
5072
5073 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
5074 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
5075 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
5076 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
5077 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
5078 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
5079 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
5080
5081 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
5082
5083 Here is an example of columns:
5084
5085 horse apple bus
5086 dog pineapple car EXTRA
5087 porcupine strawberry airplane
5088
5089 Doing the following settings:
5090
5091 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
5092 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
5093 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
5094 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
5095
5096
5097 Selecting the lines above and typing:
5098
5099 M-x delimit-columns-region
5100
5101 It results:
5102
5103 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
5104 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
5105 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
5106
5107 delim-col has the following options:
5108
5109 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
5110 before all columns.
5111
5112 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
5113 between each column.
5114
5115 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
5116 after all columns.
5117
5118 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
5119 each column.
5120
5121 delim-col has the following commands:
5122
5123 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
5124 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
5125
5126 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
5127 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
5128 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
5129 recent file list can be displayed:
5130
5131 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
5132 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
5133 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
5134
5135 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
5136 dynamically change the menu appearance.
5137
5138 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
5139 text.
5140
5141 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
5142 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
5143 specific to Message mode.
5144
5145 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
5146 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
5147 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
5148
5149 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
5150 interface to access directory servers using different directory
5151 protocols. It has a separate manual.
5152
5153 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
5154 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
5155
5156 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
5157
5158 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
5159 minibuffer with completion.
5160
5161 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
5162 with the diary features.
5163
5164 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
5165 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
5166
5167 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
5168 Fill mode.
5169
5170 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
5171 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
5172 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
5173 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
5174
5175 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
5176 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
5177 `.g'.
5178
5179 ** Changes in sort.el
5180
5181 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
5182 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
5183 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
5184 numeric base.
5185
5186 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
5187
5188 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
5189 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
5190 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
5191
5192 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
5193 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
5194
5195 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
5196 output ^M at the end of lines.
5197
5198 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
5199 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
5200
5201 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
5202 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
5203 `(msb-mode 1)'.
5204
5205 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
5206 group.
5207
5208 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
5209 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
5210 are recognized:
5211
5212 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
5213 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
5214 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
5215 nil -- just delete one character.
5216
5217 Default value is `untabify'.
5218
5219 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
5220
5221 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
5222 symbol, not double-quoted.
5223
5224 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
5225 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
5226 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
5227 moved to lisp/obsolete.
5228
5229 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
5230 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
5231 `auto-compression-mode' command.
5232
5233 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
5234 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
5235 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
5236
5237 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
5238 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
5239
5240 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
5241 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
5242
5243 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
5244 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
5245
5246 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
5247 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
5248 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
5249 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
5250 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
5251 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
5252
5253 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
5254 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
5255
5256 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
5257
5258 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
5259 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
5260
5261 ** Shell script mode changes.
5262
5263 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
5264 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
5265 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
5266
5267 ** Etags changes.
5268
5269 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
5270
5271 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
5272 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
5273 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
5274 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
5275 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
5276
5277 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
5278 declarations when given the --declarations option.
5279
5280 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
5281 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
5282
5283 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
5284 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
5285 `template' keywords.
5286
5287 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
5288 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
5289
5290 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
5291 types.
5292
5293 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
5294
5295 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
5296
5297 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
5298 are now tagged.
5299
5300 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
5301
5302 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
5303 variables are tagged.
5304
5305 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
5306
5307 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
5308 for PSWrap.
5309
5310 ** Changes in etags.el
5311
5312 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
5313 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
5314 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
5315
5316 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
5317 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
5318
5319 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
5320 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
5321 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
5322 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
5323
5324 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
5325
5326 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
5327 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
5328
5329 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
5330
5331 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
5332 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
5333 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
5334
5335 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
5336 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
5337
5338 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
5339 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
5340
5341 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
5342 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
5343 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
5344 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
5345 point will go to the beginning of the file.
5346
5347 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
5348 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
5349 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
5350
5351 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
5352 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
5353 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
5354
5355 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
5356 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
5357 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
5358
5359 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
5360
5361 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
5362
5363 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
5364 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
5365 expression from that list, are not checked.
5366
5367 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
5368 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
5369 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
5370 the buffer, just like for the local files.
5371
5372 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
5373
5374 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
5375 displays local abbrevs, only.
5376
5377 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
5378 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
5379
5380 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
5381 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
5382 is measured in pixels.
5383
5384 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
5385 to be visited as images.
5386
5387 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
5388 were added to compile.el.
5389
5390 ** Withdrawn packages
5391
5392 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
5393 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
5394
5395 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
5396
5397 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
5398
5399 \f
5400 * Incompatible Lisp changes
5401
5402 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
5403 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
5404 See the sections below for details.
5405
5406 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
5407 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
5408 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
5409 to remove the properties of the copy.
5410
5411 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
5412 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
5413 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
5414 these properties are active.
5415
5416 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
5417 ranges may affect some code.
5418
5419 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
5420 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
5421 make a difference to some code.
5422
5423 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
5424 operates on the minibuffer.
5425
5426 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
5427 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
5428 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
5429 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
5430 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
5431 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
5432 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
5433 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
5434 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
5435 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
5436 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
5437 the buffer as multibyte characters.
5438
5439 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
5440 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
5441 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
5442
5443 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
5444 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
5445 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
5446
5447 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
5448 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
5449 such as `mapconcat'.
5450
5451 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
5452 string.
5453
5454 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
5455 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
5456 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
5457 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
5458 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
5459 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
5460 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
5461 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
5462
5463 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
5464 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
5465 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
5466 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
5467 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
5468 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
5469 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
5470 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
5471 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
5472 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
5473
5474 \f
5475 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
5476 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
5477
5478 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
5479
5480 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
5481 allows the animated display of strings.
5482
5483 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
5484 interactive form of a function.
5485
5486 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
5487 between custom options. Example:
5488
5489 (defcustom default-input-method nil
5490 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
5491 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
5492 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
5493 :group 'mule
5494 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
5495 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
5496
5497 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
5498 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
5499 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
5500
5501 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
5502 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
5503 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
5504 (signal or normal termination).
5505
5506 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
5507 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
5508
5509 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5510 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5511
5512 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
5513 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
5514
5515 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
5516
5517 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
5518 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
5519 being deleted.
5520
5521 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
5522
5523 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
5524 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
5525 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
5526 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
5527 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
5528 charset.
5529
5530 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
5531 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
5532 message.
5533
5534 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
5535 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
5536
5537 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
5538 with the more general `:mask' property.
5539
5540 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
5541
5542 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
5543 backslash.
5544
5545 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
5546 is running in batch mode. For example,
5547
5548 (message "%s" (read t))
5549
5550 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
5551 to standard output.
5552
5553 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
5554 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
5555
5556 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
5557 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
5558 frame or window.
5559
5560 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
5561 were added
5562
5563 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
5564
5565 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
5566 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
5567
5568 - Function: remq ELT LIST
5569
5570 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
5571 comparison is done with `eq'.
5572
5573 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
5574
5575 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
5576 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
5577 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
5578
5579 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
5580 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
5581 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
5582
5583 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
5584 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
5585
5586 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
5587 function was declared obsolete.
5588
5589 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
5590 retained as an alias).
5591
5592 ** Easy-menu's :filter now works as in XEmacs.
5593 It takes the unconverted (i.e. XEmacs) form of the menu and the result
5594 is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
5595
5596 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
5597
5598 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
5599
5600 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
5601 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
5602 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
5603 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
5604 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
5605 means never include the minibuffer window.
5606
5607 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
5608
5609 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
5610
5611 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
5612
5613 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
5614 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
5615 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
5616 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
5617 returned.
5618
5619 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
5620 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
5621 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
5622 minibuffer even if it is active.
5623
5624 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
5625 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
5626 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
5627 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
5628 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
5629 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
5630
5631 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
5632 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
5633 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
5634 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
5635 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
5636 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
5637 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
5638
5639 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
5640 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
5641 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
5642
5643 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
5644 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
5645 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
5646 Default value is nil.
5647
5648 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
5649 meaning no limit.
5650
5651 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
5652 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
5653 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
5654
5655 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
5656 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
5657 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
5658
5659 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
5660 list of a primitive.
5661
5662 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
5663
5664 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
5665 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
5666 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
5667 than replacing the local map.
5668
5669 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
5670 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
5671 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
5672 instead.
5673
5674 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
5675
5676 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
5677 as promised long ago.
5678
5679 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
5680
5681 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
5682 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
5683 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
5684
5685 \f
5686 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
5687
5688 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
5689 regular expressions.
5690
5691 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
5692
5693 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
5694
5695 - Macro: rx SEXP
5696
5697 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
5698
5699 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
5700 notation.
5701
5702 STRING
5703 matches string STRING literally.
5704
5705 CHAR
5706 matches character CHAR literally.
5707
5708 `not-newline'
5709 matches any character except a newline.
5710 .
5711 `anything'
5712 matches any character
5713
5714 `(any SET)'
5715 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
5716 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
5717
5718 '(in SET)'
5719 like `any'.
5720
5721 `(not (any SET))'
5722 matches any character not in SET
5723
5724 `line-start'
5725 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
5726 in the text being matched
5727
5728 `line-end'
5729 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
5730
5731 `string-start'
5732 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
5733 string being matched against.
5734
5735 `string-end'
5736 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
5737 string being matched against.
5738
5739 `buffer-start'
5740 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
5741 buffer being matched against.
5742
5743 `buffer-end'
5744 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
5745 buffer being matched against.
5746
5747 `point'
5748 matches the empty string, but only at point.
5749
5750 `word-start'
5751 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
5752 word.
5753
5754 `word-end'
5755 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
5756
5757 `word-boundary'
5758 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
5759 word.
5760
5761 `(not word-boundary)'
5762 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
5763 word.
5764
5765 `digit'
5766 matches 0 through 9.
5767
5768 `control'
5769 matches ASCII control characters.
5770
5771 `hex-digit'
5772 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
5773
5774 `blank'
5775 matches space and tab only.
5776
5777 `graphic'
5778 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
5779 space, and DEL.
5780
5781 `printing'
5782 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
5783 and DEL.
5784
5785 `alphanumeric'
5786 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
5787 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
5788
5789 `letter'
5790 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
5791 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
5792
5793 `ascii'
5794 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
5795
5796 `nonascii'
5797 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
5798
5799 `lower'
5800 matches anything lower-case.
5801
5802 `upper'
5803 matches anything upper-case.
5804
5805 `punctuation'
5806 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
5807 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
5808
5809 `space'
5810 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
5811
5812 `word'
5813 matches anything that has word syntax.
5814
5815 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
5816 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
5817 of the following symbols.
5818
5819 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
5820 `punctuation' (\\s.)
5821 `word' (\\sw)
5822 `symbol' (\\s_)
5823 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
5824 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
5825 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
5826 `string-quote' (\\s\")
5827 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
5828 `escape' (\\s\\)
5829 `character-quote' (\\s/)
5830 `comment-start' (\\s<)
5831 `comment-end' (\\s>)
5832
5833 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
5834 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
5835
5836 `(category CATEGORY)'
5837 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
5838 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
5839
5840 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
5841 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
5842 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
5843 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
5844 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
5845 `symbol' (\\c5)
5846 `digit' (\\c6)
5847 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
5848 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
5849 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
5850 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
5851 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
5852 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
5853 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
5854 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
5855 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
5856 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
5857 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
5858 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
5859 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
5860 `ascii' (\\ca)
5861 `arabic' (\\cb)
5862 `chinese' (\\cc)
5863 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
5864 `greek' (\\cg)
5865 `korean' (\\ch)
5866 `indian' (\\ci)
5867 `japanese' (\\cj)
5868 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
5869 `latin' (\\cl)
5870 `lao' (\\co)
5871 `tibetan' (\\cq)
5872 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
5873 `thai' (\\ct)
5874 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
5875 `hebrew' (\\cw)
5876 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
5877 `can-break' (\\c|)
5878
5879 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
5880 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
5881
5882 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
5883 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
5884
5885 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
5886 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
5887 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
5888
5889 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
5890 another name for `submatch'.
5891
5892 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
5893 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
5894 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
5895 regular expression.
5896
5897 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
5898 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
5899 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
5900 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
5901 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
5902
5903 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
5904 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
5905
5906 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
5907 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
5908
5909 `(0+ SEXP)'
5910 like `zero-or-more'.
5911
5912 `(* SEXP)'
5913 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
5914
5915 `(*? SEXP)'
5916 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
5917
5918 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
5919 matches one or more occurrences of A.
5920
5921 `(1+ SEXP)'
5922 like `one-or-more'.
5923
5924 `(+ SEXP)'
5925 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
5926
5927 `(+? SEXP)'
5928 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
5929
5930 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
5931 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
5932
5933 `(optional SEXP)'
5934 like `zero-or-one'.
5935
5936 `(? SEXP)'
5937 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
5938
5939 `(?? SEXP)'
5940 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
5941
5942 `(repeat N SEXP)'
5943 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
5944
5945 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
5946 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
5947
5948 `(eval FORM)'
5949 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
5950 `regexp-quote' it.
5951
5952 `(regexp REGEXP)'
5953 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
5954
5955 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
5956
5957 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
5958 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
5959 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
5960 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
5961
5962 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
5963 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
5964 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
5965 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
5966
5967 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
5968 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
5969 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
5970
5971 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
5972 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
5973 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
5974 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
5975 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
5976 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
5977 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
5978 eight-bit-graphic.
5979
5980 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
5981
5982 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
5983 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
5984 character set as previously.
5985
5986 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
5987 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
5988 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
5989
5990 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
5991 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
5992 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
5993 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
5994
5995 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
5996 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
5997
5998 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
5999 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
6000 "fontset-default".
6001
6002 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
6003 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
6004
6005 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
6006 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
6007 buffers and strings.
6008
6009 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
6010 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
6011 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
6012 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
6013 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
6014 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
6015 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
6016 also been deleted.
6017
6018 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
6019 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
6020 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
6021
6022 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
6023 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
6024 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
6025 may differ between buffer and string text.
6026
6027 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
6028 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
6029
6030 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
6031 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
6032 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
6033 `composition' from STRING.
6034
6035 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
6036 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
6037
6038 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
6039 obsolete.
6040
6041 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
6042 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
6043
6044 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
6045 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
6046 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
6047 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
6048
6049 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
6050 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
6051 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
6052 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
6053 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
6054 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
6055
6056 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
6057 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
6058 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
6059
6060 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
6061 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
6062 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
6063
6064 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
6065 have been introduced.
6066
6067 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6068 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
6069 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
6070 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
6071 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
6072 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
6073 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
6074 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
6075 their multibyte equivalent.
6076
6077 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
6078 that offset in the file before writing.
6079
6080 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
6081 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
6082
6083 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
6084 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
6085 from which the command was issued.
6086
6087 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
6088 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
6089 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
6090 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
6091 operate on.
6092
6093 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
6094 to `window-buffer-height'.
6095
6096 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
6097
6098 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
6099 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
6100 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
6101
6102 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
6103 respectively.
6104
6105 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
6106 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
6107
6108 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
6109 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
6110 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
6111
6112 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
6113 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
6114 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
6115 is currently displayed in some window.
6116
6117 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
6118 argument function's results.
6119
6120 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
6121 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
6122 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
6123 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
6124 sequence).
6125
6126 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
6127 header in the list of headers passed to it.
6128
6129 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
6130 ignores differences in case and text representation.
6131
6132 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
6133 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
6134 as follows:
6135
6136 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
6137 nil don't display a cursor
6138 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
6139 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
6140 others display a box cursor.
6141
6142 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
6143 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
6144 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
6145 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
6146
6147 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
6148 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
6149 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
6150 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
6151
6152 Example:
6153
6154 (string-to-syntax "()")
6155 => (4 . 41)
6156
6157 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
6158 other than 10.
6159
6160 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
6161 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
6162
6163 #b1111
6164 => 15
6165 #b-1111
6166 => -15
6167
6168 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
6169
6170 #o666
6171 => 438
6172
6173 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
6174
6175 #xbeef
6176 => 48815
6177
6178 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
6179
6180 #2R-111
6181 => -7
6182 #25rah
6183 => 267
6184
6185 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
6186 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
6187 and isn't a string.
6188
6189 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
6190 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
6191 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
6192 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
6193
6194 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
6195
6196 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
6197 for a regexp in a string.
6198
6199 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
6200 `mouse-position-function'.
6201
6202 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
6203 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
6204
6205 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
6206 Keywords are now always considered constants.
6207
6208 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
6209 returns it.
6210
6211 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
6212 returned by function `recent-keys'.
6213
6214 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
6215 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
6216 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
6217 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
6218 mode.
6219
6220 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
6221 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
6222
6223 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
6224 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
6225 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
6226 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
6227 been performed."
6228
6229 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
6230 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
6231 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
6232 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
6233
6234 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
6235 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
6236 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
6237
6238 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
6239 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
6240 specified table.
6241
6242 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
6243
6244 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
6245 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
6246 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
6247 what BODY returns.
6248
6249 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
6250 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
6251 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
6252 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
6253 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
6254
6255 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
6256 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
6257
6258 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
6259 instead of being optional.
6260
6261 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
6262 modify read-only text.
6263
6264 ** New functions and variables for locales.
6265
6266 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
6267 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
6268 time functions like strftime. The new variables
6269 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
6270 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
6271
6272 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
6273 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
6274 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
6275 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
6276 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
6277 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
6278 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
6279
6280 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
6281 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
6282 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
6283 start sequences.
6284
6285 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
6286 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
6287
6288 ** New function `propertize'
6289
6290 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
6291 strings with text properties.
6292
6293 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
6294
6295 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
6296 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
6297 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
6298 specified value of that property. Example:
6299
6300 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
6301
6302 ** push and pop macros.
6303
6304 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
6305 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
6306 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
6307
6308 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
6309 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
6310 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
6311
6312 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
6313
6314 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
6315 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
6316
6317 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
6318 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
6319 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
6320 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
6321
6322 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
6323 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
6324 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
6325 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
6326
6327 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
6328 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
6329 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
6330 or a sign.
6331
6332 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
6333 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
6334 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
6335 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
6336 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
6337 space, and DEL.
6338 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
6339 and DEL.
6340 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
6341 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6342 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6343 [:alpha:] matches letters.
6344 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6345 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6346 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
6347 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
6348 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
6349 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
6350 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6351 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
6352 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
6353 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
6354 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
6355
6356 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
6357
6358 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
6359
6360 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
6361
6362 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
6363 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
6364
6365 :test TEST
6366
6367 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
6368 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
6369 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
6370
6371 :size SIZE
6372
6373 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
6374 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
6375
6376 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
6377
6378 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
6379 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
6380 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
6381 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
6382 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
6383
6384 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
6385
6386 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
6387 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
6388 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
6389
6390 :weakness WEAK
6391
6392 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
6393 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
6394 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
6395 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
6396 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
6397
6398 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
6399
6400 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
6401
6402 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
6403
6404 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
6405
6406 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
6407
6408 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
6409 values are shared.
6410
6411 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
6412
6413 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
6414
6415 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
6416
6417 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
6418
6419 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
6420
6421 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
6422
6423 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
6424
6425 Returns the size of TABLE.
6426
6427 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
6428
6429 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
6430
6431 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
6432
6433 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
6434
6435 - Function: clrhash TABLE
6436
6437 Clear TABLE.
6438
6439 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
6440
6441 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
6442 not found.
6443
6444 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
6445
6446 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
6447 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
6448
6449 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
6450
6451 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
6452
6453 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
6454
6455 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
6456 arguments KEY and VALUE.
6457
6458 - Function: sxhash OBJ
6459
6460 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
6461
6462 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
6463
6464 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
6465 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
6466 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
6467 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
6468 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
6469
6470 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
6471
6472 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
6473 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
6474 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
6475
6476 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
6477 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
6478
6479 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
6480 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
6481
6482 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
6483 (sxhash (upcase a)))
6484
6485 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
6486 'case-fold-string-hash))
6487
6488 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
6489
6490 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
6491
6492 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
6493 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
6494 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
6495
6496 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
6497
6498 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
6499 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
6500
6501 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
6502 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
6503 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
6504 is too short to reach that column.
6505
6506 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
6507 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
6508 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
6509 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
6510
6511 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
6512 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
6513 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
6514
6515 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
6516 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
6517
6518 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
6519 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
6520
6521 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
6522 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
6523 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
6524 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
6525 temporary-file-directory instead.
6526
6527 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
6528 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
6529 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
6530 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
6531
6532 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
6533 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
6534
6535 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
6536
6537 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
6538 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
6539 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
6540
6541 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
6542
6543 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
6544 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
6545 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
6546 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
6547 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
6548 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
6549
6550 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
6551 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
6552 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
6553 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
6554
6555 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
6556
6557 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
6558 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
6559 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
6560 result string.
6561
6562 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
6563 string where arguments appear in the result string.
6564
6565 Example:
6566
6567 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
6568 (s2 "world"))
6569 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
6570 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
6571 (format s1 s2))
6572
6573 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
6574
6575 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
6576
6577 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
6578 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
6579 argument in it.
6580
6581 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
6582 (arg "world"))
6583 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
6584 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
6585 (message msg arg))
6586
6587 ** Sound support
6588
6589 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
6590 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
6591
6592 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
6593 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
6594 to enable sound support.
6595
6596 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
6597 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
6598 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
6599 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
6600 sound to play, before playing the sound.
6601
6602 The following sound properties are supported:
6603
6604 - `:file FILE'
6605
6606 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
6607 searched relative to `data-directory'.
6608
6609 - `:data DATA'
6610
6611 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
6612 may be present, but not both.
6613
6614 - `:volume VOLUME'
6615
6616 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
6617 0..1. This property is optional.
6618
6619 - `:device DEVICE'
6620
6621 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
6622 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
6623
6624 Other properties are ignored.
6625
6626 An alternative interface is called as
6627 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
6628
6629 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
6630
6631 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
6632 a keyword symbol.
6633
6634 ** Changes to garbage collection
6635
6636 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
6637 of live and free strings.
6638
6639 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
6640 strings that have been consed so far.
6641
6642 \f
6643 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
6644 Lisp Manual
6645
6646 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
6647 mini-windows.
6648
6649 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
6650 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
6651 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
6652
6653 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
6654
6655 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
6656
6657 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
6658 image.
6659
6660 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
6661
6662 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
6663
6664 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
6665 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
6666 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
6667 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
6668 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
6669
6670 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
6671 has a mask bitmap.
6672
6673 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
6674
6675 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
6676 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
6677 or omitted means use the selected frame.
6678
6679 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
6680 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
6681
6682 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
6683 optional.
6684
6685 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
6686 below).
6687
6688 \f
6689 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
6690
6691 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
6692 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
6693
6694 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
6695 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
6696 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
6697 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
6698 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
6699 just display it black instead.
6700
6701 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
6702 a line like
6703
6704 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
6705
6706 in your `.emacs'.
6707
6708 ** New face implementation.
6709
6710 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
6711 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
6712
6713 *** New faces.
6714
6715 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
6716
6717 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
6718
6719 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
6720 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
6721
6722 3. Font height in 1/10pt
6723
6724 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
6725
6726 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
6727
6728 6. Foreground color.
6729
6730 7. Background color.
6731
6732 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
6733
6734 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
6735
6736 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
6737
6738 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
6739
6740 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
6741 color.
6742
6743 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
6744 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
6745
6746 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
6747 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
6748 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
6749 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
6750 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
6751 attributes mentioned above.
6752
6753 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
6754 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
6755 created frames.
6756
6757 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
6758 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
6759 `fully-specified'.
6760
6761 *** Face merging.
6762
6763 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
6764 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
6765 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
6766 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
6767 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
6768 results in a fully-specified face.
6769
6770 *** Face realization.
6771
6772 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
6773 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
6774 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
6775 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
6776 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
6777 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
6778
6779 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
6780 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
6781 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
6782 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
6783
6784 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
6785 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
6786 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
6787 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
6788 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
6789
6790 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
6791 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
6792 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
6793 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
6794 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
6795 Emacs.
6796
6797 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
6798 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
6799 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
6800 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
6801
6802 **** Clearing face caches.
6803
6804 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
6805 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
6806 unused fonts.
6807
6808 *** Font selection.
6809
6810 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
6811 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
6812 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
6813
6814 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
6815 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
6816 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
6817 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
6818 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
6819
6820 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
6821 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
6822 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
6823
6824 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
6825
6826 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
6827 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
6828 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
6829 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
6830 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
6831 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
6832 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
6833
6834 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
6835 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
6836 doesn't exist.
6837
6838 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
6839 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
6840 registry.
6841
6842 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
6843 slightly different.
6844
6845 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
6846
6847
6848 **** Scalable fonts
6849
6850 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
6851 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
6852 servers.
6853
6854 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
6855 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
6856 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
6857 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
6858 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
6859 that list. Example:
6860
6861 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
6862
6863 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
6864
6865 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
6866
6867 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
6868
6869 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
6870 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
6871 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
6872
6873 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
6874 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
6875 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
6876 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
6877 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
6878 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
6879 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
6880 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
6881 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
6882 of the face font sort order.
6883
6884 - Function: x-font-family-list
6885
6886 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
6887 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
6888 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
6889 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
6890
6891 - Variable: font-list-limit
6892
6893 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
6894 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
6895 matching font. The default is currently 100.
6896
6897 *** Setting face attributes.
6898
6899 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
6900 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
6901 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
6902 `face-attribute'.
6903
6904 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
6905 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
6906
6907 The following attributes are recognized:
6908
6909 `:family'
6910
6911 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
6912 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
6913 and `?' are allowed.
6914
6915 `:width'
6916
6917 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
6918 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
6919 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
6920 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
6921
6922 `:height'
6923
6924 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
6925 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
6926 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
6927 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
6928
6929 `:weight'
6930
6931 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
6932 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
6933 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
6934
6935 `:slant'
6936
6937 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
6938 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
6939 `reverse-oblique'.
6940
6941 `:foreground', `:background'
6942
6943 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
6944
6945 `:underline'
6946
6947 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
6948 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
6949 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
6950 don't underline.
6951
6952 `:overline'
6953
6954 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
6955 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
6956 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
6957 overline.
6958
6959 `:strike-through'
6960
6961 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
6962 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
6963 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
6964 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
6965
6966 `:box'
6967
6968 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
6969 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
6970 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
6971 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
6972 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
6973 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
6974 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
6975 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
6976 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
6977 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
6978 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
6979 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
6980 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
6981 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
6982 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
6983 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
6984 box.
6985
6986 `:inverse-video'
6987
6988 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
6989 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
6990
6991 `:stipple'
6992
6993 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
6994 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
6995 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
6996 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
6997 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
6998 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
6999
7000 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
7001 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
7002
7003 `:font'
7004
7005 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
7006 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
7007 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
7008 versions of Emacs.
7009
7010 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
7011 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
7012 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
7013
7014 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
7015 `defface'.
7016
7017 `:inherit'
7018
7019 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
7020 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
7021 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
7022
7023 *** Face attributes and X resources
7024
7025 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
7026 from X resources:
7027
7028 Face attribute X resource class
7029 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
7030 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
7031 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
7032 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
7033 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
7034 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
7035 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
7036 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
7037 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
7038 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
7039 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
7040 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
7041 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
7042 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
7043 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
7044 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
7045 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
7046 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
7047 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
7048 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
7049
7050 *** Text property `face'.
7051
7052 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
7053 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
7054 specification can be
7055
7056 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
7057
7058 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
7059 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
7060 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
7061 for face attribute names.
7062
7063 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
7064 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
7065 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
7066
7067 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
7068
7069 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
7070 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
7071 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
7072 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
7073 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
7074 used to clear the mapping table.
7075
7076 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
7077
7078 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
7079 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
7080 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
7081 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
7082 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
7083 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
7084 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
7085 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
7086 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
7087 modify their color-related behavior.
7088
7089 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
7090 any frame type.
7091
7092 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
7093
7094 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
7095 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
7096 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
7097 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
7098 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
7099 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
7100 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
7101 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
7102 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
7103
7104 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
7105 display can display image files.
7106
7107 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
7108
7109 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
7110 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
7111 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
7112 `Inviolable' option.
7113
7114 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
7115 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
7116 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
7117
7118 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
7119
7120 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
7121 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
7122 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
7123
7124 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
7125 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
7126 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
7127 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
7128 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
7129 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
7130 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
7131 functions.
7132
7133 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
7134 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
7135 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
7136
7137 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
7138
7139 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
7140
7141 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
7142
7143 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7144 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
7145 constrained position if that is different.
7146
7147 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
7148 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
7149 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
7150 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
7151 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7152 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
7153 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
7154 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
7155 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
7156
7157 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
7158 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
7159 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
7160 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
7161 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
7162
7163 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
7164 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
7165
7166 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
7167
7168 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
7169
7170 Delete the field surrounding POS.
7171 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7172 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7173
7174 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7175
7176 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
7177 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7178 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7179 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
7180 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
7181
7182 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7183
7184 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
7185 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7186 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7187 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
7188 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
7189
7190 - Function: field-string &optional POS
7191
7192 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
7193 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7194 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7195
7196 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
7197
7198 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
7199 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7200 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7201
7202 ** Image support.
7203
7204 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
7205 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
7206 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
7207 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
7208
7209 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
7210 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
7211 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
7212 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
7213 area.
7214
7215 IMAGE is an image specification.
7216
7217 *** Image specifications
7218
7219 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
7220 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
7221 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
7222 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
7223 described below are ignored.
7224
7225 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
7226
7227 `:ascent ASCENT'
7228
7229 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
7230 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
7231 to use for its ascent.
7232
7233 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
7234 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
7235
7236 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
7237 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
7238 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
7239 overlays that apply to the image.
7240
7241 `:margin MARGIN'
7242
7243 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
7244 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
7245 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
7246
7247 `:relief RELIEF'
7248
7249 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
7250 around an image.
7251
7252 `:conversion ALGO'
7253
7254 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
7255
7256 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
7257 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
7258
7259 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
7260 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
7261 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
7262 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
7263 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
7264 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
7265 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
7266 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
7267 below.
7268
7269 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
7270 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
7271 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
7272
7273 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
7274 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
7275 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
7276 of the factors' absolute values.
7277
7278 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
7279
7280 (1 0 0
7281 0 0 0
7282 9 9 -1)
7283
7284 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
7285
7286 ( 2 -1 0
7287 -1 0 1
7288 0 1 -2)
7289
7290 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
7291 ``disabled''.
7292
7293 `:mask MASK'
7294
7295 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
7296 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
7297 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
7298 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
7299 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
7300 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
7301 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
7302 image.
7303
7304 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
7305 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
7306 `:mask nil'.
7307
7308 `:file FILE'
7309
7310 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
7311 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
7312 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
7313 may be present in the image specification.
7314
7315 `:data DATA'
7316
7317 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
7318 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
7319 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
7320 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
7321
7322 *** Supported image types
7323
7324 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
7325
7326 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
7327 properties supported are:
7328
7329 `:foreground FG'
7330
7331 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
7332 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
7333
7334 `:background BG'
7335
7336 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
7337 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
7338
7339 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
7340 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
7341 instead of a `:file' property.
7342
7343 `:width WIDTH'
7344
7345 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
7346
7347 `:height HEIGHT'
7348
7349 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
7350
7351 `:data DATA'
7352
7353 DATA must be either
7354
7355 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
7356 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
7357
7358 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
7359
7360 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
7361 bitmap.
7362
7363 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
7364 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
7365 in the file.
7366
7367 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
7368
7369 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
7370 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
7371 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
7372 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
7373
7374 Additional image properties supported are:
7375
7376 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
7377
7378 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
7379 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
7380 name.
7381
7382 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
7383 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
7384
7385 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
7386 to display compressed images.
7387
7388 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
7389
7390 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
7391 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
7392 mono images are:
7393
7394 `:foreground FG'
7395
7396 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
7397 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
7398
7399 `:background FG'
7400
7401 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
7402 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
7403
7404 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
7405
7406 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
7407 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
7408 properties defined.
7409
7410 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
7411
7412 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
7413 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
7414 properties defined.
7415
7416 **** GIF, image type `gif'
7417
7418 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
7419 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
7420
7421 Additional image properties supported are:
7422
7423 `:index INDEX'
7424
7425 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
7426 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
7427 as a hollow box.
7428
7429 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
7430 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
7431 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
7432 every 0.1 seconds.
7433
7434 (defun show-anim (file max)
7435 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
7436 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
7437
7438 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
7439 (when (= idx max)
7440 (setq idx 0))
7441 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
7442 (save-excursion
7443 (set-buffer buffer)
7444 (goto-char (point-min))
7445 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
7446 (insert-image img "x"))
7447 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
7448
7449 **** PNG, image type `png'
7450
7451 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
7452 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
7453 properties defined.
7454
7455 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
7456
7457 Additional image properties supported are:
7458
7459 `:pt-width WIDTH'
7460
7461 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
7462 integer. This is a required property.
7463
7464 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
7465
7466 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
7467 must be a integer. This is an required property.
7468
7469 `:bounding-box BOX'
7470
7471 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
7472 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
7473 files. This is an required property.
7474
7475 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
7476 lisp/gs.el.
7477
7478 *** Lisp interface.
7479
7480 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
7481 which are supported in the current configuration.
7482
7483 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
7484 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
7485 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
7486 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
7487 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
7488
7489 *** Simplified image API, image.el
7490
7491 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
7492 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
7493 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
7494 define an image based on available image types. The functions
7495 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
7496 buffer.
7497
7498 ** Display margins.
7499
7500 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
7501 and images.
7502
7503 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
7504 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
7505 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
7506 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
7507 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
7508 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
7509 of the display margins.
7510
7511 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
7512 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
7513 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
7514 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
7515 in this file).
7516
7517 ** Help display
7518
7519 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
7520 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
7521 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
7522 that have a `help-echo' property.
7523
7524 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
7525 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
7526 the window in which the help was found.
7527
7528 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
7529 `help-echo' text property was found.
7530
7531 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
7532 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
7533
7534 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
7535 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
7536 mouse.
7537
7538 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
7539 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
7540
7541 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
7542 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
7543 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
7544 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
7545 used as help string.
7546
7547 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
7548 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
7549 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
7550
7551 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
7552
7553 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
7554 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
7555
7556 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
7557 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
7558 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
7559 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
7560 used.
7561
7562 (global-set-key [A-down]
7563 #'(lambda ()
7564 (interactive)
7565 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
7566 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
7567 (global-set-key [A-up]
7568 #'(lambda ()
7569 (interactive)
7570 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
7571 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
7572
7573 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
7574
7575 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
7576 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
7577 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
7578 is called with one argument, POS.
7579
7580 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
7581 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
7582 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
7583 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
7584 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
7585
7586 ** Tool bar support.
7587
7588 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
7589 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
7590 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
7591 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
7592 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
7593 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
7594
7595 *** Tool bar item definitions
7596
7597 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
7598 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
7599 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
7600
7601 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
7602 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
7603 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
7604 property (see below).
7605
7606 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
7607 binding are currently ignored.
7608
7609 The following properties are recognized:
7610
7611 `:enable FORM'.
7612
7613 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
7614 or disabled.
7615
7616 `:visible FORM'
7617
7618 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
7619
7620 `:filter FUNCTION'
7621
7622 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
7623 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
7624 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
7625
7626 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
7627
7628 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
7629 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
7630
7631 `:image IMAGES'
7632
7633 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
7634 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
7635 meaning of each of the four elements:
7636
7637 Index Use when item is
7638 ----------------------------------------
7639 0 enabled and selected
7640 1 enabled and deselected
7641 2 disabled and selected
7642 3 disabled and deselected
7643
7644 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
7645 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
7646
7647 `:help HELP-STRING'.
7648
7649 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
7650 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
7651
7652 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
7653 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
7654 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
7655 menu bar.
7656
7657 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
7658 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
7659 buffer-locally to override the global map.
7660
7661 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
7662
7663 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
7664 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
7665 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
7666
7667 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
7668 raised when the mouse moves over them.
7669
7670 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
7671 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
7672 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
7673 vertical margins . Default is 1.
7674
7675 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
7676 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
7677
7678 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
7679
7680 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
7681 a tool bar item. If
7682
7683 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
7684 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
7685 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
7686
7687 is the original tool bar item definition, then
7688
7689 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
7690
7691 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
7692 item.
7693
7694 ** Mode line changes.
7695
7696 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
7697
7698 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
7699 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
7700 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
7701
7702 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
7703 a `local-map' text property.
7704
7705 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
7706 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
7707
7708 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
7709 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
7710 `local-map' property.
7711
7712 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
7713 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
7714 example.
7715
7716 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
7717 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
7718
7719 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
7720 variable mode-line-format to nil.
7721
7722 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
7723
7724 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
7725 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
7726 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
7727 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
7728 line.
7729
7730 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
7731 `header-line'.
7732
7733 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
7734 position in the header-line.
7735
7736 ** Text property `display'
7737
7738 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
7739 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
7740 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
7741 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
7742 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
7743
7744 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
7745
7746 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
7747 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
7748
7749 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
7750 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
7751 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
7752 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
7753 simpler form STRING as property value.
7754
7755 *** Variable width and height spaces
7756
7757 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
7758 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
7759 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
7760 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
7761 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
7762 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
7763 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
7764
7765 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
7766 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
7767 properties described below.
7768
7769 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
7770 characters having the `display' property.
7771
7772 - :width WIDTH
7773
7774 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
7775 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
7776
7777 - :relative-width FACTOR
7778
7779 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
7780 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
7781 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
7782 width of that character by FACTOR.
7783
7784 - :align-to HPOS
7785
7786 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
7787 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
7788
7789 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
7790
7791 - :height HEIGHT
7792
7793 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
7794 normal line height.
7795
7796 - :relative-height FACTOR
7797
7798 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
7799 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
7800
7801 - :ascent ASCENT
7802
7803 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
7804 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
7805 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
7806 equal to 100.
7807
7808 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
7809
7810 *** Images
7811
7812 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
7813 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
7814 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
7815 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
7816 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
7817 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
7818 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
7819 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
7820 as display specification.
7821
7822 *** Other display properties
7823
7824 - (space-width FACTOR)
7825
7826 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
7827 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
7828 integer or float.
7829
7830 - (height HEIGHT)
7831
7832 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
7833
7834 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
7835 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
7836 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
7837 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
7838 a font is available counts as a step.
7839
7840 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
7841 as tall as the frame's default font.
7842
7843 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
7844 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
7845
7846 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
7847 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
7848
7849 - (raise FACTOR)
7850
7851 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
7852 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
7853 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
7854 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
7855 `height' subproperty.
7856
7857 *** Conditional display properties
7858
7859 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
7860 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
7861 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
7862 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
7863 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
7864 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
7865 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
7866 different when object is a string.
7867
7868 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
7869 `(when t . SPEC)'.
7870
7871 ** New menu separator types.
7872
7873 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
7874 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
7875 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
7876 to specify other menu separator types.
7877
7878 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
7879
7880 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
7881 separator occurs.
7882
7883 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
7884
7885 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
7886
7887 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
7888
7889 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
7890
7891 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
7892
7893 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
7894
7895 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
7896
7897 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
7898
7899 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
7900
7901 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
7902 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
7903
7904 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
7905
7906 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
7907
7908 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
7909
7910 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
7911
7912 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
7913
7914 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
7915
7916 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
7917
7918 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
7919
7920 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
7921
7922 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
7923
7924 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
7925
7926 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
7927
7928 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
7929
7930 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
7931
7932 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
7933 the corresponding single-line separators.
7934
7935 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
7936
7937 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
7938 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
7939 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
7940 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
7941 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
7942 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
7943 default foreground is black.
7944
7945 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
7946 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
7947 `ScrollBarBackground').
7948
7949 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
7950 settings for scroll bar colors.
7951
7952 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
7953 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
7954
7955 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
7956 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
7957 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
7958 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
7959 the original window start.
7960
7961 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
7962 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
7963 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
7964
7965 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
7966
7967 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
7968 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
7969 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
7970 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
7971
7972 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
7973 fixed-width and fixed-height.
7974
7975 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
7976
7977 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
7978 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
7979 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
7980 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
7981 temporarily to nil, for example
7982
7983 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
7984 (enlarge-window 10))
7985
7986 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
7987 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
7988
7989 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
7990 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
7991 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
7992 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
7993 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
7994 support a vertical-bar cursor).
7995
7996
7997 \f
7998 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
7999
8000 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
8001 input.
8002
8003 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
8004
8005 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
8006
8007 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
8008 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
8009 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
8010 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
8011 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
8012
8013 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
8014 been added.
8015
8016 \f
8017 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
8018
8019 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
8020
8021
8022 \f
8023 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
8024
8025 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
8026 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
8027 \f
8028 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
8029
8030 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
8031
8032 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
8033 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
8034 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
8035
8036 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
8037 is the one that is used.
8038
8039 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
8040 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
8041 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
8042 separate from the command's regular output.
8043 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
8044 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
8045 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
8046 the buffer name.
8047
8048 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
8049 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
8050 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
8051 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
8052
8053 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
8054 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
8055 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
8056 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
8057
8058 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
8059 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
8060 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
8061 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
8062
8063 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
8064 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
8065 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
8066 they never ignore case.
8067
8068 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
8069 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
8070 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
8071 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
8072 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
8073 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
8074 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
8075
8076 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
8077 the same format that was used in the file before.
8078
8079 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
8080 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
8081
8082 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
8083 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
8084 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
8085
8086 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
8087 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
8088 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
8089 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
8090 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
8091 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
8092 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
8093
8094 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
8095 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
8096 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
8097 format. You can now customize these variables.
8098
8099 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
8100 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
8101 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
8102 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
8103
8104 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
8105 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
8106 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
8107
8108 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
8109 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
8110 doesn't have any effect.
8111
8112 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
8113 not one per buffer.
8114
8115 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
8116 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
8117 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
8118
8119 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
8120 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
8121 `auto-show-mode' command.
8122
8123 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
8124 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
8125 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
8126 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
8127 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
8128
8129 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
8130 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
8131
8132 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
8133 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
8134 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
8135
8136 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
8137 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
8138 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
8139 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
8140
8141 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
8142
8143 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
8144 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
8145 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
8146 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
8147 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
8148
8149 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
8150 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
8151
8152 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
8153 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
8154 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
8155 `?' on other systems.
8156
8157 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
8158 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
8159 Unix.
8160
8161 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
8162 current codepage when it starts.
8163
8164 ** Mail changes
8165
8166 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
8167 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
8168 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
8169 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
8170 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
8171 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
8172 latin-1:
8173
8174 MIME-version: 1.0
8175 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
8176 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
8177
8178 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
8179 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
8180 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
8181 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
8182 buffer-file-coding-system.
8183
8184 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
8185 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
8186 mail.
8187
8188 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
8189 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
8190 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
8191 list of possible coding systems.
8192
8193 ** CC Mode changes
8194
8195 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
8196 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
8197 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
8198 docstring for details.
8199
8200 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
8201 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
8202 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
8203 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
8204 lineup functions use this feature currently.
8205
8206 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
8207 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
8208
8209 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
8210 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
8211
8212 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
8213 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
8214 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
8215 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
8216 anonymous classes.
8217
8218 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
8219 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
8220
8221 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
8222 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
8223 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
8224 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
8225
8226 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
8227 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
8228 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
8229 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
8230 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
8231
8232 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
8233
8234 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
8235
8236 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
8237 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
8238
8239 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
8240
8241 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
8242 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
8243 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
8244 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
8245 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
8246
8247 ** Gnus changes.
8248
8249 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
8250 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
8251 Gnus manual for the full story.
8252
8253 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
8254 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
8255 group, which is created automatically.
8256
8257 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
8258 values.
8259
8260 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
8261
8262 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
8263 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
8264
8265 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
8266 `C-u C-c C-c'.
8267
8268 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
8269
8270 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
8271 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
8272
8273 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
8274
8275 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
8276 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
8277
8278 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
8279 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
8280
8281 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
8282 control over simplification.
8283
8284 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
8285
8286 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
8287 limit.
8288
8289 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
8290
8291 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
8292
8293 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
8294 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
8295 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
8296
8297 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
8298 `a' forces normal posting method.
8299
8300 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
8301 -- `W d'.
8302
8303 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
8304 to a non-nil value.
8305
8306 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
8307 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
8308
8309 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
8310 has been added.
8311
8312 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
8313
8314 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
8315
8316 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
8317 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
8318
8319 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
8320 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
8321
8322 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
8323
8324 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
8325 been added.
8326
8327 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
8328 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
8329
8330 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
8331 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
8332
8333 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
8334
8335 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
8336
8337 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
8338
8339 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
8340
8341 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
8342 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
8343 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
8344
8345 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
8346 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
8347 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
8348 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
8349 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
8350
8351 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
8352 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
8353 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
8354 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
8355
8356 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
8357 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
8358 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
8359 mismatch.
8360
8361 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
8362
8363 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
8364 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
8365
8366 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
8367 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
8368 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
8369 removed from the label.
8370
8371 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
8372 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
8373
8374 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
8375 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
8376
8377 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
8378 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
8379 expressions.
8380
8381 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
8382
8383 ** New/deleted modes and packages
8384
8385 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
8386 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
8387
8388 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
8389 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
8390 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
8391
8392 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
8393 changes with a special face.
8394
8395 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
8396 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
8397 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
8398 \f
8399 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
8400
8401 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
8402 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
8403 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
8404 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
8405 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
8406
8407 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
8408 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
8409 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
8410
8411 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
8412 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
8413 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
8414 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
8415 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
8416 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
8417 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
8418 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
8419 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
8420
8421 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
8422 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
8423 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
8424 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
8425 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
8426 program.
8427
8428 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
8429 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
8430 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
8431 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
8432 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
8433 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
8434
8435 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
8436 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
8437 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
8438 was not documented clearly before.
8439
8440 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
8441 This includes Tetris and Snake.
8442 \f
8443 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
8444
8445 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
8446 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
8447 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
8448 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
8449
8450 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
8451 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
8452 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
8453
8454 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
8455
8456 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
8457 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
8458
8459 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
8460 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
8461 integers.
8462
8463 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
8464 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
8465 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
8466 file names and attributes are returned.
8467
8468 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
8469 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
8470 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
8471 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
8472 returns the result.
8473
8474 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
8475 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
8476
8477 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
8478
8479 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
8480 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
8481 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
8482 optionally.
8483
8484 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
8485 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
8486
8487 **
8488 The new function process-running-child-p
8489 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
8490 terminal to its own child process.
8491
8492 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
8493 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
8494 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
8495 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
8496
8497 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
8498 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
8499
8500 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
8501 :included is an alias for :visible.
8502
8503 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
8504 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
8505 to move or copy menu entries.
8506
8507 ** Multibyte editing changes
8508
8509 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
8510 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
8511 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
8512 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
8513 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
8514 (setq char (sref str idx)
8515 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
8516 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
8517
8518 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
8519 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
8520 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
8521
8522 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
8523 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
8524 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
8525
8526 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
8527
8528 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
8529 across the boundary.
8530
8531 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
8532 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
8533 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
8534 contains 8-bit characters.
8535 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
8536 contains invalid characters.
8537
8538 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
8539 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
8540 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
8541 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
8542 way.
8543
8544 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
8545 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
8546 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
8547 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
8548
8549 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
8550 compose Thai characters in a string.
8551
8552 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
8553 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
8554 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
8555 menus should always use the third argument.
8556
8557 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
8558 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
8559 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
8560 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
8561
8562 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
8563 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
8564 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
8565 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
8566
8567 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
8568 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
8569 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
8570 echo area contents.
8571
8572 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
8573
8574 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
8575 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
8576 requested feature cannot be loaded.
8577
8578 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
8579 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
8580 means to clear out that attribute.
8581
8582 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
8583 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
8584
8585 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
8586 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
8587 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
8588 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
8589
8590 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
8591 the gap of the current buffer.
8592
8593 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
8594 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
8595 current buffer.
8596
8597 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
8598 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
8599 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
8600 it back in after any modifications have been made.
8601 \f
8602 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
8603
8604 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
8605 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
8606 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
8607 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
8608 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
8609
8610 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
8611 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
8612 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
8613 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
8614 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
8615
8616 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
8617 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
8618 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
8619
8620 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
8621 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
8622 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
8623 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
8624 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
8625 results.
8626
8627 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
8628 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
8629 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
8630 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
8631 \f
8632 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
8633
8634 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
8635 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
8636 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
8637 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
8638
8639 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
8640 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
8641 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
8642 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
8643 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
8644 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
8645 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
8646 region.
8647
8648 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
8649 selective undo.
8650
8651 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
8652 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
8653 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
8654 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
8655 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
8656
8657 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
8658 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
8659 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
8660 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
8661
8662 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
8663 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
8664 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
8665 something that most users not do.
8666
8667 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
8668 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
8669 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
8670 applications.
8671
8672 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
8673 pasting operations.
8674
8675 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
8676 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
8677 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
8678 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
8679 `ps-printer-name'.
8680
8681 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
8682 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
8683 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
8684 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
8685 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
8686 hits a new word.
8687
8688 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
8689 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
8690 to be confused by TeX commands.
8691
8692 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
8693 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
8694 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
8695 of various alternative replacements and actions.
8696
8697 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
8698 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
8699 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
8700 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
8701 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
8702
8703 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
8704 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
8705
8706 ** Changes in input method usage.
8707
8708 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
8709 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
8710 respectively.
8711
8712 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
8713
8714 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
8715 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
8716
8717 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
8718 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
8719
8720 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
8721
8722 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
8723
8724 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
8725 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
8726
8727 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
8728 given in the following case:
8729 o When you are using a complex input method.
8730 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
8731
8732 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
8733 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
8734 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
8735 setting it to t is helpful.
8736
8737 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
8738
8739 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
8740 keys:
8741 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
8742 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
8743 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
8744 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
8745 environment.
8746
8747 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
8748 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
8749 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
8750 get
8751
8752 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
8753
8754 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
8755
8756 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
8757 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
8758
8759 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
8760 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
8761 its owner and group.
8762
8763 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
8764 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
8765
8766 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
8767 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
8768
8769 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
8770 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
8771 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
8772 by the left edge of the rectangle.
8773
8774 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
8775 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
8776 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
8777 for writing keyboard macros.
8778
8779 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
8780 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
8781 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
8782 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
8783 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
8784 info.
8785
8786 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
8787
8788 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
8789 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
8790 contents only.
8791
8792 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
8793 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
8794 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
8795 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
8796
8797 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
8798 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
8799 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
8800
8801 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
8802 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
8803 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
8804 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
8805
8806 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
8807 failure if the command produces no output.
8808
8809 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
8810 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
8811 the mouse.
8812
8813 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
8814 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
8815 function and variable names.
8816
8817 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
8818 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
8819 file-coding-system-alist.
8820
8821 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
8822 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
8823 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
8824 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
8825 according to the current fontset.
8826
8827 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
8828
8829 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
8830 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
8831 nonascii-insert-offset.
8832
8833 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
8834 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
8835 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
8836 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
8837
8838 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
8839 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
8840
8841 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
8842 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
8843
8844 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
8845 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
8846 command keys.
8847
8848 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
8849 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
8850
8851 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
8852 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
8853 all variables that have documentation.
8854
8855 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
8856 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
8857 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
8858 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
8859 it should show; the default is 20.
8860
8861 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
8862 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
8863 of your input.
8864
8865 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
8866 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
8867 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
8868 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
8869 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
8870 Newly added options are included as well.
8871
8872 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
8873 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
8874 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
8875
8876 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
8877 Customize menu.
8878
8879 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
8880 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
8881
8882 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
8883 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
8884 invoked.
8885
8886 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
8887 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
8888 The default is 1.
8889
8890 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
8891 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
8892 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
8893 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
8894 sensibly.
8895
8896 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
8897
8898 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
8899 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
8900 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
8901
8902 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
8903 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
8904 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
8905 every night.
8906
8907 ** Desktop changes
8908
8909 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
8910 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
8911
8912 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
8913 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
8914
8915 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
8916 read and post multi-lingual articles.
8917
8918 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
8919 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
8920 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
8921 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
8922 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
8923 made invisible again.
8924
8925 ** Mail reading and sending changes
8926
8927 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
8928 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
8929 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
8930 toggle.
8931
8932 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
8933 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
8934 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
8935 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
8936 rmail-default-body-file.
8937
8938 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
8939 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
8940 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
8941
8942 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
8943 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
8944 is evaluated to insert the signature.
8945
8946 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
8947 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
8948 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
8949 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
8950 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
8951 especially interested in trying feedmail.
8952
8953 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
8954 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
8955 provided by feedmail are:
8956
8957 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
8958 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
8959 there is also a queue for draft messages
8960
8961 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
8962 be prompted for confirmation
8963
8964 **** does smart filling of address headers
8965
8966 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
8967 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
8968 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
8969
8970 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
8971 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
8972 /usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
8973 function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
8974
8975 ** Dired changes
8976
8977 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
8978 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
8979
8980 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
8981 run Dired on the directory name at point.
8982
8983 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
8984 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
8985 for a specified regexp.
8986
8987 ** VC Changes
8988
8989 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
8990 conveniently.
8991
8992 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
8993 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
8994 Dired.
8995
8996 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
8997 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
8998 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
8999 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
9000
9001 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
9002 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
9003 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
9004 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
9005 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
9006
9007 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
9008 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
9009 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
9010 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
9011 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
9012
9013 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
9014 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
9015 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
9016 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
9017
9018 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
9019 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
9020 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
9021
9022 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
9023 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
9024 session to resolve them.
9025
9026 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
9027 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
9028 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
9029 uses as well).
9030
9031 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
9032 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
9033 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
9034 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
9035 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
9036 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
9037 using ediff.
9038
9039 ** Changes in Font Lock
9040
9041 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
9042 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
9043 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
9044 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
9045 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
9046
9047 ** Frame name display changes
9048
9049 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
9050 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
9051 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
9052 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
9053
9054 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
9055 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
9056 menu.
9057
9058 ** Comint (subshell) changes
9059
9060 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
9061 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
9062 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
9063
9064 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
9065
9066 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
9067 that is, the line after the last line you got.
9068 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
9069
9070 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
9071 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
9072 the following line.
9073
9074 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
9075 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
9076 previously sent input.
9077
9078 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
9079 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
9080 as the search string.
9081
9082 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
9083 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
9084
9085 ** C mode changes
9086
9087 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
9088 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
9089 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
9090 definition.
9091
9092 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
9093 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
9094 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
9095 style is still the default however.
9096
9097 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
9098
9099 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
9100 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
9101 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
9102
9103 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
9104 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
9105
9106 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
9107 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
9108
9109 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
9110 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
9111
9112 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
9113 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
9114
9115 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
9116 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
9117 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
9118 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
9119
9120 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
9121
9122 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
9123 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
9124 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
9125
9126 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
9127 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
9128 expanding dynamically.
9129
9130 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
9131 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
9132
9133 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
9134 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
9135 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
9136 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
9137
9138 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
9139
9140 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
9141
9142 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
9143 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
9144 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
9145 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
9146 against the first word in the title.
9147
9148 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
9149 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
9150 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
9151 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
9152 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
9153 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
9154
9155 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
9156 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
9157 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
9158 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
9159
9160 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
9161
9162 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
9163 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
9164 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
9165 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
9166 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
9167 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
9168
9169 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
9170 Editing group once the package is loaded.
9171
9172 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
9173 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
9174 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
9175
9176 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
9177 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
9178
9179 ** Ispell changes.
9180
9181 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
9182 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
9183 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
9184
9185 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
9186 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
9187 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
9188 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
9189 include:
9190
9191 o URLs are automatically skipped
9192 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
9193
9194 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
9195
9196 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
9197
9198 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
9199 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
9200 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
9201 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
9202
9203 *** New recursive parser.
9204
9205 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
9206 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
9207 recursive parser scans the individual files.
9208
9209 *** Parsing only part of a document.
9210
9211 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
9212 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
9213 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
9214
9215 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
9216
9217 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
9218
9219 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
9220
9221 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
9222
9223 *** Using multiple selection buffers
9224
9225 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
9226 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
9227
9228 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
9229
9230 *** References to external documents.
9231
9232 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
9233 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
9234 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
9235 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
9236 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
9237 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
9238 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
9239
9240 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
9241
9242 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
9243 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
9244
9245 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
9246 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
9247
9248 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
9249
9250 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
9251 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
9252
9253 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
9254
9255 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
9256 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
9257 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
9258 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
9259 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
9260 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
9261 more.
9262
9263 *** Support for the varioref package
9264
9265 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
9266
9267 *** New hooks
9268
9269 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
9270 and citations are created. These hooks are
9271 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
9272 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
9273
9274 *** Citations outside LaTeX
9275
9276 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
9277 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
9278
9279 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
9280
9281 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
9282 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
9283 fontified, use
9284
9285 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
9286
9287 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
9288 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
9289 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
9290 directories that contain the same file name.
9291
9292 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
9293 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
9294 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
9295 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
9296 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
9297 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
9298 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
9299 directory.
9300
9301 ** New modes and packages
9302
9303 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
9304 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
9305 it, but some do not.
9306
9307 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
9308 code.
9309
9310 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
9311 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
9312 around in a buffer.
9313
9314 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
9315
9316 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
9317 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
9318 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
9319 established system of notation similar to Chess.
9320
9321 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
9322 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
9323 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
9324
9325 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
9326 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
9327 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
9328 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
9329 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
9330 the like.
9331
9332 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
9333 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
9334
9335 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
9336 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
9337 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
9338 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
9339
9340 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
9341
9342 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
9343 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
9344 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
9345 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
9346 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
9347 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
9348 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
9349 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
9350 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
9351 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
9352 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
9353
9354 Platform-specific modes:
9355
9356 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
9357 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
9358 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
9359 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
9360 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
9361 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
9362 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
9363 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
9364 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
9365 \f
9366 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
9367
9368 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
9369 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
9370 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
9371 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
9372
9373 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
9374 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
9375 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
9376
9377 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
9378 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
9379 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
9380 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
9381
9382 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
9383 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
9384 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
9385 environment.
9386
9387 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
9388 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
9389 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
9390 current input method for reading this one event.
9391
9392 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
9393 now control whether to output certain characters as
9394 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
9395 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
9396 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
9397 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
9398 \f
9399 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
9400
9401 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
9402 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
9403
9404 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
9405 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
9406 always increases point by 1.
9407
9408 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
9409 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
9410
9411 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
9412
9413 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
9414 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
9415 default value changed. For example,
9416
9417 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
9418 :type 'integer
9419 :group 'foo
9420 :version "20.3")
9421
9422 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
9423 :version "20.3")
9424
9425 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
9426 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
9427 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
9428 `:version' in the top level group.
9429
9430 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
9431
9432 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
9433 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
9434
9435 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
9436 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
9437 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
9438 to themselves.
9439
9440 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
9441 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
9442 values whatever.
9443
9444 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
9445 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
9446 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
9447
9448 ** Frame-local variables.
9449
9450 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
9451 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
9452 local bindings for that variable.
9453
9454 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
9455 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
9456 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
9457 parameter name.
9458
9459 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
9460 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
9461 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
9462 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
9463
9464 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
9465 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
9466 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
9467 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
9468
9469 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
9470 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
9471 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
9472 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
9473 See the documentation in sregex.el.
9474
9475 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
9476 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
9477 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
9478 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
9479
9480 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
9481 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
9482
9483 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
9484 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
9485 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
9486
9487 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
9488 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
9489 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
9490 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
9491
9492 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
9493 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
9494 empty input.
9495
9496 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
9497 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
9498 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
9499 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
9500 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
9501
9502 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
9503 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
9504 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
9505 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
9506
9507 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
9508 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
9509 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
9510 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
9511 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
9512
9513 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
9514 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
9515 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
9516 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
9517
9518 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
9519 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
9520 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
9521
9522 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
9523 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
9524 was directed to display this buffer.
9525
9526 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
9527 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
9528 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
9529 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
9530 set-window-configuration.
9531
9532 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
9533 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
9534 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
9535 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
9536
9537 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
9538 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
9539 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
9540
9541 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
9542 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
9543 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
9544
9545 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
9546 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
9547
9548 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
9549 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
9550
9551 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
9552 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
9553 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
9554
9555 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
9556 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
9557 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
9558 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
9559
9560 ** Menu changes
9561
9562 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
9563 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
9564 better supported.
9565
9566 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
9567 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
9568 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
9569 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
9570 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
9571
9572 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
9573
9574 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
9575 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
9576 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
9577 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
9578
9579 The format is:
9580 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
9581 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
9582 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
9583 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
9584 The supported properties include
9585
9586 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
9587 item is enabled.
9588 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
9589 item should appear in the menu.
9590 :filter FILTER-FN
9591 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
9592 which will be REAL-BINDING.
9593 It should return a binding to use instead.
9594 :keys DESCRIPTION
9595 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
9596 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
9597 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
9598 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
9599 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
9600 keyboard binding.
9601 :key-sequence nil
9602 This means that the command normally has no
9603 keyboard equivalent.
9604 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
9605 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
9606 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
9607 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
9608 value says whether this button is currently selected.
9609
9610 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
9611 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
9612
9613 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
9614
9615 ** New event types
9616
9617 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
9618 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
9619 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
9620 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
9621
9622 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
9623
9624 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
9625 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
9626 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
9627 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
9628 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
9629 forward, away from the user.
9630
9631 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
9632
9633 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
9634 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
9635 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
9636 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
9637 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
9638
9639 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
9640
9641 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
9642 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
9643 that were dragged and dropped.
9644
9645 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
9646
9647 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
9648
9649 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
9650 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
9651 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
9652
9653 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
9654 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
9655 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
9656
9657 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
9658 in Emacs 19 and before.
9659
9660 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
9661 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
9662
9663 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
9664 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
9665 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
9666 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
9667
9668 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
9669 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
9670 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
9671 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
9672 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
9673
9674 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
9675 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
9676 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
9677 consistent with the new representation.
9678
9679 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
9680 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
9681 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
9682 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
9683
9684 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
9685 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
9686 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
9687
9688 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
9689 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
9690 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
9691
9692 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
9693 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
9694 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
9695
9696 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
9697 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
9698
9699 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
9700 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
9701
9702 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
9703 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
9704 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
9705 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
9706
9707 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
9708 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
9709
9710 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
9711 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
9712 buffer or string being searched.
9713
9714 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
9715 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
9716 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
9717 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
9718 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
9719 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
9720 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
9721
9722 *** Structure of coding system changed.
9723
9724 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
9725 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
9726 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
9727 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
9728 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
9729 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
9730 define-coding-system-alias.
9731
9732 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
9733 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
9734 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
9735 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
9736 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
9737 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
9738 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
9739 `iso-8859-1'.
9740
9741 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
9742 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
9743 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
9744 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
9745
9746 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
9747 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
9748 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
9749 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
9750
9751 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
9752 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
9753 This function requires a user interaction.
9754
9755 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
9756 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
9757 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
9758 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
9759 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
9760 select-safe-coding-system.
9761
9762 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
9763 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
9764 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
9765 was done.
9766
9767 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
9768 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
9769 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
9770
9771 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
9772 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
9773 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
9774 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
9775
9776 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
9777 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
9778 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
9779 converted.
9780
9781 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
9782 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
9783
9784 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
9785 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
9786 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
9787 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
9788 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
9789 range of characters.
9790
9791 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
9792 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
9793
9794 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
9795 in the current buffer at position POS.
9796
9797 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
9798 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
9799 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
9800 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
9801 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
9802 binding input-method-function to nil.
9803
9804 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
9805 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
9806 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
9807 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
9808 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
9809
9810 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
9811 subsequent events of a key sequence.
9812
9813 *** You can customize any language environment by using
9814 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
9815
9816 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
9817 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
9818 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
9819 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
9820 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
9821 \f
9822 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
9823
9824 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
9825 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
9826 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
9827 tree structure.
9828
9829 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
9830 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
9831
9832 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
9833 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
9834 in your .emacs file.)
9835
9836 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
9837 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
9838
9839 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
9840 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
9841
9842 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
9843 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
9844 kills the region.
9845
9846 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
9847 delete the character before point, as usual.
9848
9849 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
9850 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
9851 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
9852
9853 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
9854 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
9855 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
9856 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
9857 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
9858 past.)
9859
9860 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
9861 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
9862 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
9863 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
9864 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
9865
9866 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
9867 and is an alias for it.
9868
9869 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
9870 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
9871
9872 ** Scrolling changes
9873
9874 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
9875 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
9876
9877 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
9878 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
9879 where it started.
9880
9881 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
9882 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
9883 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
9884 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
9885
9886 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
9887 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
9888 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
9889 recenters the window.
9890
9891 ** International character set support (MULE)
9892
9893 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
9894 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
9895 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
9896 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
9897 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
9898 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
9899
9900 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
9901 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
9902 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
9903 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
9904 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
9905
9906 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
9907 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
9908 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
9909 language, to make it possible to type them.
9910
9911 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
9912 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
9913
9914 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
9915 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
9916
9917 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
9918
9919 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
9920
9921 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
9922 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
9923 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
9924 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
9925 characters for their work until they want to change.
9926
9927 *** Input methods
9928
9929 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
9930 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
9931 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
9932 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
9933 support several input methods.
9934
9935 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
9936 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
9937 work.
9938
9939 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
9940 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
9941 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
9942 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
9943 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
9944 letter.
9945
9946 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
9947 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
9948 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
9949 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
9950 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
9951
9952 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
9953 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
9954 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
9955 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
9956
9957 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
9958 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
9959 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
9960 the first guess is wrong.
9961
9962 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
9963 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
9964
9965 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
9966 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
9967 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
9968 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
9969
9970 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
9971 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
9972 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
9973 translate automatically to and from either one.
9974
9975 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
9976
9977 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
9978 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
9979 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
9980 what you want.
9981
9982 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
9983 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
9984 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
9985 multibyte characters in that buffer.
9986
9987 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
9988 character conversion as well.
9989
9990 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
9991
9992 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
9993 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
9994 requires using many fonts.
9995
9996 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
9997 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
9998
9999 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
10000 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
10001 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
10002 you would use a font.
10003
10004 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
10005 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
10006 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
10007
10008 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
10009 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
10010 characters).
10011
10012 *** Defining fontsets.
10013
10014 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
10015 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
10016 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
10017
10018 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
10019 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
10020 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
10021 standard fontset are created automatically.
10022
10023 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
10024 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
10025 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
10026 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
10027 name is `fontset-startup'.
10028
10029 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
10030 The resource value should have this form:
10031 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
10032 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
10033 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
10034 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
10035 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
10036 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
10037 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
10038 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
10039 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
10040
10041 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
10042 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
10043 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
10044
10045 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
10046 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
10047 following resource,
10048 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
10049 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
10050 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
10051 Here is the substitution rule:
10052 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
10053 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
10054 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
10055 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
10056 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
10057
10058 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
10059 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
10060 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
10061
10062 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
10063 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
10064 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
10065 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
10066 fontsets.
10067
10068 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
10069 defaults for a particular choice of language.
10070
10071 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
10072 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
10073 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
10074 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
10075 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
10076 system for new files that you create.
10077
10078 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
10079 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
10080 whole Emacs session.
10081
10082 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
10083 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
10084 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
10085
10086 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
10087 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
10088 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
10089 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
10090 coding systems that Emacs supports.
10091
10092 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
10093 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
10094 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
10095 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
10096 is used for *the immediately following command*.
10097
10098 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
10099 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
10100
10101 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
10102 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
10103
10104 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
10105 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
10106
10107 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
10108 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
10109 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
10110 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
10111 of the file.
10112
10113 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
10114 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
10115 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
10116 translated into that character code.
10117
10118 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
10119 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
10120
10121 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
10122
10123 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
10124 the coding system for keyboard input.
10125
10126 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
10127 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
10128 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
10129
10130 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
10131
10132 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
10133 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
10134 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
10135 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
10136 designed to work with terminals.
10137
10138 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
10139 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
10140 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
10141 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
10142 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
10143 in the corresponding buffer.
10144
10145 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
10146
10147 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
10148 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
10149 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
10150
10151 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
10152 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
10153 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
10154 want to use.
10155
10156 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
10157 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
10158
10159 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
10160 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
10161 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
10162 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
10163
10164 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
10165 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
10166 related information.
10167
10168 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
10169 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
10170 scripts.
10171
10172 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
10173 information about the support for a particular language.
10174 You specify the language as an argument.
10175
10176 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
10177 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
10178 first dash.
10179
10180 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
10181 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
10182 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
10183 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
10184
10185 A alternativnyj (Russian)
10186 B big5 (Chinese)
10187 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
10188 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
10189 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
10190 E euc-japan (Japanese)
10191 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
10192 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
10193 K euc-korea (Korean)
10194 R koi8 (Russian)
10195 Q tibetan
10196 S shift_jis (Japanese)
10197 T lao
10198 T tis620 (Thai)
10199 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
10200 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
10201 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
10202 v viqr (Vietnamese)
10203 z hz (Chinese)
10204
10205 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
10206 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
10207 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
10208 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
10209
10210 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
10211 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
10212
10213 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
10214 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
10215 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
10216 Rmail files themselves.
10217
10218 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
10219 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
10220
10221 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
10222 for sending mail:
10223
10224 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
10225 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
10226 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
10227 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
10228 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
10229
10230 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
10231 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
10232 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
10233 translations.
10234
10235 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
10236 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
10237 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
10238 without any conversion.
10239
10240 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
10241 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
10242 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
10243 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
10244
10245 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
10246 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
10247
10248 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
10249 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
10250
10251 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
10252 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
10253
10254 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
10255 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
10256 in the buffer before point.
10257
10258 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
10259 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
10260 you are using.
10261
10262 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
10263 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
10264
10265 ** File locking works with NFS now.
10266
10267 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
10268 in the same directory as FILENAME.
10269
10270 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
10271 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
10272 can become a bottleneck.
10273
10274 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
10275 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
10276 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
10277 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
10278 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
10279 so useful that the change is worth while.
10280
10281 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
10282 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
10283 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
10284 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
10285
10286 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
10287 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
10288 show-paren-mode.
10289
10290 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
10291 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
10292 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
10293
10294 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
10295 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
10296 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
10297
10298 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
10299 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
10300 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
10301
10302 ** Changes in View mode.
10303
10304 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
10305 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
10306
10307 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
10308 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
10309
10310 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
10311 previous state.
10312
10313 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
10314 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
10315
10316 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
10317 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
10318 not just the selected window.
10319
10320 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
10321 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
10322 turns View mode on or off.
10323
10324 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
10325 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
10326 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
10327
10328 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
10329 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
10330
10331 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
10332 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
10333 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
10334 which version to compare with.
10335
10336 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
10337 blocks if a match is inside the block.
10338
10339 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
10340 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
10341 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
10342 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
10343
10344 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
10345 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
10346 blocks, all of them or none.
10347
10348 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
10349 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
10350 confirmation first.
10351
10352 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
10353 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
10354 However, the mode will not be changed if
10355 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
10356 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
10357 not suitable for ordinary files, or
10358 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
10359
10360 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
10361
10362 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
10363 these commands do not change the major mode.
10364
10365 ** M-x occur changes.
10366
10367 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
10368 it performs a case-sensitive search.
10369
10370 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
10371 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
10372 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
10373
10374 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
10375 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
10376 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
10377 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
10378 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
10379
10380 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
10381 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
10382 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
10383 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
10384
10385 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
10386 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
10387 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
10388
10389 ** Outline mode changes.
10390
10391 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
10392
10393 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
10394
10395 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
10396 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
10397 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
10398 was already active.
10399
10400 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
10401 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
10402 get confused by it.
10403
10404 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
10405 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
10406
10407 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
10408
10409 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
10410 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
10411 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
10412 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
10413
10414 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
10415 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
10416 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
10417
10418 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
10419 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
10420 values.
10421
10422 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
10423 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
10424 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
10425 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
10426
10427 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
10428 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
10429 can be. The default value is 30.
10430
10431 ** Changes in Mail mode.
10432
10433 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
10434 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
10435 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
10436 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
10437 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
10438 behavior.
10439
10440 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
10441 compose-mail-other-frame.
10442
10443 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
10444 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
10445 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
10446 buffer that shows the original message.
10447
10448 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
10449 with separator lines around the contents.
10450
10451 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
10452 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
10453 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
10454 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
10455
10456 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
10457
10458 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
10459 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
10460 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
10461 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
10462
10463 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
10464 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
10465 /etc/passwd.
10466
10467 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
10468 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
10469 /etc/passwd.
10470
10471 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
10472 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
10473 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
10474 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
10475
10476 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
10477 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
10478 be taken to be magic.
10479
10480 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
10481 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
10482 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
10483
10484 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
10485 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
10486
10487 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
10488 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
10489
10490 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
10491
10492 new key dired.el binding old key
10493 ------- ---------------- -------
10494 * c dired-change-marks c
10495 * m dired-mark m
10496 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
10497 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
10498 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
10499 * u dired-unmark u
10500 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
10501 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
10502 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
10503 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
10504 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
10505 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
10506
10507 ** Rmail changes.
10508
10509 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
10510 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
10511 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
10512 each time you run it.
10513
10514 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
10515 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
10516
10517 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
10518 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
10519 means to move in the opposite direction.
10520
10521 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
10522 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
10523
10524 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
10525 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
10526 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
10527 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
10528 for output.
10529
10530 ** Gnus changes.
10531
10532 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
10533
10534 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
10535 Gnus.
10536
10537 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
10538 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
10539
10540 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
10541 article mode line.
10542
10543 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
10544
10545 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
10546
10547 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
10548
10549 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
10550 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
10551 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
10552
10553 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
10554
10555 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
10556
10557 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
10558 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
10559
10560 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
10561 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
10562 used to pick articles.
10563
10564 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
10565 another have been added.
10566
10567 `M-x gnus-change-server'
10568
10569 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
10570 generating lines in buffers.
10571
10572 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
10573 `C-M-_'.
10574
10575 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
10576
10577 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
10578
10579 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
10580
10581 *** Scores can be decayed.
10582
10583 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
10584
10585 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
10586 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
10587
10588 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
10589 the native server.
10590
10591 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
10592
10593 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
10594 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
10595
10596 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
10597
10598 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
10599 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
10600
10601 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
10602 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
10603
10604 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
10605 a group.
10606
10607 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
10608 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
10609
10610 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
10611
10612 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
10613
10614 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
10615
10616 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
10617
10618 Use the `Y c' command.
10619
10620 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
10621
10622 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
10623
10624 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
10625
10626 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
10627 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
10628
10629 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
10630
10631 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
10632
10633 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
10634 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
10635
10636 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
10637
10638 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
10639 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
10640 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
10641 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
10642 this issue.)
10643
10644 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
10645 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
10646 particular news group. This can be done by:
10647
10648 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
10649
10650 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
10651 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
10652 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
10653 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
10654 for reading and posting).
10655
10656 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
10657 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
10658 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
10659 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
10660 there.
10661
10662 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
10663 default. Here are some of these default settings:
10664
10665 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
10666 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
10667 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
10668 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
10669 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
10670
10671 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
10672 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
10673
10674 ** CC mode changes.
10675
10676 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
10677 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
10678 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
10679 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
10680 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
10681 loaded.
10682
10683 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
10684 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
10685 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
10686 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
10687 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
10688 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
10689
10690 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
10691 of the current buffer.
10692
10693 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
10694 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
10695 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
10696
10697 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
10698 style that the Python developers like.
10699
10700 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
10701 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
10702 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
10703
10704 ** VC Changes [new]
10705
10706 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
10707 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
10708 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
10709
10710 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
10711 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
10712 developers.
10713
10714 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
10715 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
10716
10717 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
10718 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
10719 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
10720 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
10721
10722 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
10723 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
10724
10725 ** Calendar changes.
10726
10727 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
10728 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
10729 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
10730 following/previous years.
10731
10732 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
10733 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
10734 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
10735 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
10736 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
10737 supposed attribute of God.
10738
10739 ** ps-print changes
10740
10741 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
10742 layout.
10743
10744 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
10745
10746 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
10747 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
10748 printer system has this behavior, set variable
10749 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
10750
10751 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
10752 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
10753 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
10754
10755 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
10756 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
10757
10758 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
10759 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
10760 printing for your printer.
10761
10762 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
10763 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
10764
10765 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
10766 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
10767
10768 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
10769 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
10770 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
10771 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
10772 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
10773 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
10774 The default value is nil.
10775
10776 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
10777 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
10778
10779 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
10780 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
10781 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
10782 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
10783 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
10784 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
10785 color). The default is 0 ("black").
10786
10787 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
10788 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
10789
10790 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
10791 The default is 0 ("black").
10792
10793 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
10794 The default is 0 ("black").
10795
10796 border-width Specify the border width.
10797 The default is 0.4.
10798
10799 Any other property is ignored.
10800
10801 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
10802 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
10803 documentation).
10804
10805 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
10806 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
10807 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
10808 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
10809 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
10810 controlling headers.
10811
10812 *** Color management (subgroup)
10813
10814 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
10815 color.
10816
10817 *** Face Management (subgroup)
10818
10819 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
10820 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
10821 background should be used. Valid values are:
10822
10823 t always use face background color.
10824 nil never use face background color.
10825 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
10826
10827 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
10828
10829 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
10830 sheet of paper.
10831
10832 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
10833 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
10834
10835 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
10836 each page.
10837
10838 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
10839 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
10840 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
10841
10842 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
10843 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
10844 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
10845
10846 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
10847 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
10848 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
10849
10850 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
10851 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
10852 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
10853
10854 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
10855 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
10856 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
10857
10858 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
10859
10860 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
10861
10862 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
10863 RGB color.
10864
10865 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
10866 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
10867 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
10868
10869 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
10870 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
10871 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
10872 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
10873 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
10874 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
10875 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
10876 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
10877 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
10878 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
10879 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
10880 10 + 10 +
10881 11 + 11 +
10882 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
10883 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
10884 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
10885 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
10886 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
10887 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
10888 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
10889 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
10890 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
10891 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
10892 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
10893 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
10894 22 + 22 +
10895 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
10896
10897 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
10898
10899
10900 *** Printer management (subgroup)
10901
10902 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
10903 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
10904 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
10905 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
10906 to "-P".
10907
10908 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
10909 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
10910 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
10911
10912 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
10913 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
10914 do so.
10915
10916 *** Page settings (subgroup)
10917
10918 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
10919 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
10920 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
10921 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
10922 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
10923 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
10924 `setpagedevice'.
10925
10926 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
10927 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
10928 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
10929
10930 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
10931 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
10932 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
10933 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
10934 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
10935 its TO, are ignored.
10936
10937 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
10938 pages. Valid values are:
10939
10940 nil print all pages.
10941
10942 `even-page' print only even pages.
10943
10944 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
10945
10946 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
10947 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
10948 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
10949 print only the even sheet of paper.
10950
10951 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
10952 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
10953 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
10954 only the odd sheet of paper.
10955
10956 Any other value is treated as nil.
10957
10958 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
10959 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
10960 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
10961
10962 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
10963
10964 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
10965 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
10966
10967 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
10968 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
10969 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
10970 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
10971 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
10972 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
10973 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
10974
10975 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
10976 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
10977 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
10978 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
10979 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
10980 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
10981 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
10982
10983 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
10984
10985 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
10986 messages should be sent.
10987
10988 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
10989 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
10990 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
10991
10992 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
10993
10994 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
10995 points for line numbers.
10996
10997 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
10998 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
10999
11000 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
11001 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
11002 to 2, the printing will look like:
11003
11004 1 one line
11005 one line
11006 3 one line
11007 one line
11008 5 one line
11009 one line
11010 ...
11011
11012 Valid values are:
11013
11014 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
11015 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
11016 is used.
11017
11018 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
11019 zebra stripe is to be printed.
11020
11021 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
11022
11023 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
11024 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
11025 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
11026 3, the output will look like:
11027
11028 one line
11029 one line
11030 3 one line
11031 one line
11032 one line
11033 6 one line
11034 one line
11035 one line
11036 9 one line
11037 one line
11038 ...
11039
11040 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
11041 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
11042
11043 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
11044 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
11045 `ps-font-size').
11046
11047 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
11048 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
11049 `ps-font-size').
11050
11051 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
11052
11053 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
11054 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
11055
11056 ** hideshow changes.
11057
11058 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
11059 C++, ; for lisp).
11060
11061 *** Support for java-mode added.
11062
11063 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
11064 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
11065
11066 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
11067 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
11068 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
11069
11070 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
11071 robust and a lot faster.
11072
11073 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
11074
11075 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
11076 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
11077 documentation for more details.
11078
11079 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
11080
11081 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
11082 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
11083 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
11084 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
11085 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
11086
11087 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
11088 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
11089 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
11090 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
11091
11092 ** Font Lock mode
11093
11094 *** Custom support
11095
11096 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
11097 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
11098 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
11099 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
11100 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
11101 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
11102
11103 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
11104
11105 *** Maximum decoration
11106
11107 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
11108 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
11109 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
11110 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
11111 to get the old behavior.
11112
11113 *** New support
11114
11115 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
11116
11117 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
11118 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
11119
11120 *** Configurable support
11121
11122 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
11123 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
11124 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
11125 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
11126 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
11127 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
11128 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
11129
11130 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
11131 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
11132 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
11133
11134 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
11135
11136 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
11137 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
11138 for any mode.
11139
11140 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
11141
11142 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
11143
11144 in your ~/.emacs.
11145
11146 *** New faces
11147
11148 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
11149 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
11150 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
11151 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
11152
11153 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
11154
11155 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
11156 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
11157 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
11158
11159 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
11160
11161 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
11162 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
11163 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
11164 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
11165 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
11166 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
11167 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
11168
11169 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
11170 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
11171 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
11172 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
11173 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
11174 the command M-g M-g (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
11175
11176 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
11177
11178 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
11179 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
11180 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
11181 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
11182
11183 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
11184 settings.
11185
11186 ** Ada mode changes.
11187
11188 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
11189 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
11190 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
11191 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
11192 stubs.
11193
11194 *** There are two new commands:
11195 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
11196 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
11197
11198 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
11199 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
11200 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
11201
11202 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
11203 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
11204 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
11205
11206 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
11207 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
11208 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
11209 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
11210
11211 ** Scheme mode changes.
11212
11213 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
11214 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
11215 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
11216 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
11217 have any effect.
11218
11219 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
11220 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
11221 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
11222 variables as buffer-local variables.
11223
11224 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
11225 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
11226
11227 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
11228
11229 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
11230 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
11231 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
11232 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
11233
11234 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
11235 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
11236 buffer in Emacs.
11237
11238 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
11239 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
11240 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
11241 option takes precedence.
11242
11243 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
11244 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
11245 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
11246
11247 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
11248 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
11249 the current defun.
11250
11251 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
11252 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
11253
11254 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
11255 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
11256 necessary).
11257
11258 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
11259 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
11260 these register values no longer become completely useless.
11261 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
11262 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
11263 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
11264
11265 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
11266 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
11267 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
11268 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
11269
11270 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
11271 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
11272 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
11273 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
11274 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
11275
11276 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
11277 since it applies only to the current frame.
11278
11279 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
11280 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
11281 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
11282
11283 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
11284 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
11285 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
11286 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
11287 instead of just the file you are editing.
11288
11289 ** RefTeX mode
11290
11291 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
11292 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
11293 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
11294 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
11295 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
11296
11297 C-c ( reftex-label
11298 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
11299 knows which kind of label is needed.
11300
11301 C-c ) reftex-reference
11302 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
11303 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
11304
11305 C-c [ reftex-citation
11306 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
11307 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
11308
11309 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
11310 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
11311
11312 C-c = reftex-toc
11313 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
11314 can quickly jump to every section.
11315
11316 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
11317 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
11318 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
11319 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
11320 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
11321
11322 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11323
11324 *** Info documentation is now available.
11325
11326 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
11327 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
11328
11329 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
11330 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
11331
11332 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
11333 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
11334
11335 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
11336 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
11337 appropriate functions.
11338
11339 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
11340 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
11341
11342 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
11343 been cleaned.
11344
11345 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
11346 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
11347
11348 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
11349 shall be delimited.
11350
11351 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
11352 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
11353 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
11354
11355 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
11356 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
11357 prefixed with `ALT'.
11358
11359 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
11360 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
11361 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
11362 documentation).
11363
11364 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
11365 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
11366 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
11367
11368 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
11369 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
11370
11371 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
11372 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
11373 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
11374
11375 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
11376
11377 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
11378
11379 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
11380 from alien sources.
11381
11382 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
11383 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
11384 crossref entries.
11385
11386 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
11387 region.
11388
11389 *** Added support for imenu.
11390
11391 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
11392 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
11393 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
11394 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
11395
11396 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
11397 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
11398
11399 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
11400
11401 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
11402
11403 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
11404 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
11405 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
11406 as an argument.
11407
11408 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
11409 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
11410
11411 ** browse-url changes
11412
11413 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
11414 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
11415 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
11416 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
11417 customization variables.
11418
11419 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
11420
11421 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
11422 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
11423 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
11424
11425 ** Changes in Ediff
11426
11427 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
11428 pops up the Info file for this command.
11429
11430 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
11431 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
11432 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
11433 directories).
11434
11435 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
11436 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
11437 files in the same directory.
11438
11439 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
11440 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
11441 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
11442
11443 ** Changes in Viper
11444
11445 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
11446 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
11447 instead of vip-.
11448 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
11449 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
11450 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
11451 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
11452 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
11453 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
11454 color when Viper is in insert state.
11455 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
11456 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
11457 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
11458
11459 ** Etags changes.
11460
11461 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
11462 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
11463 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
11464 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
11465 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
11466
11467 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
11468
11469 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
11470 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
11471
11472 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
11473 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
11474 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
11475
11476 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
11477 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
11478 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
11479 methods and protocols.
11480
11481 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
11482 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
11483 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
11484 paragraph name.
11485
11486 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
11487 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
11488 at least M times and as many as N times.
11489
11490 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
11491 in files has changed slightly.
11492
11493 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
11494 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
11495 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
11496 with old time-stamp-format values.
11497
11498 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
11499 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
11500 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
11501 reasons.
11502
11503 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
11504 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
11505 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
11506 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
11507 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
11508 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
11509
11510 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
11511 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
11512 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
11513
11514 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
11515 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
11516 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
11517 recommended now will continue to work then.
11518
11519 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
11520 details.
11521
11522 ** There are some additional major modes:
11523
11524 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
11525 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
11526 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
11527
11528 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
11529 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
11530 into Emacs.
11531
11532 ** New Lisp packages include:
11533
11534 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
11535
11536 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
11537 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
11538
11539 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
11540
11541 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
11542 in shell buffers.
11543
11544 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
11545 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
11546 and `elint-defun'.
11547
11548 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
11549 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
11550 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
11551 strings or comments.
11552
11553 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
11554 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
11555 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
11556 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
11557 at these points.
11558
11559 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
11560 can visit them by short forms of their names.
11561
11562 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
11563 Emacs Lisp function at point.
11564
11565 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
11566
11567 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
11568 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
11569
11570 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
11571
11572 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
11573
11574 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
11575
11576 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
11577 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
11578
11579 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
11580 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
11581 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
11582 original place after inserting the copy.
11583
11584 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
11585 on the buffer.
11586
11587 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
11588 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
11589 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
11590
11591 Enable mouse-drag with:
11592 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
11593 -or-
11594 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
11595
11596 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
11597 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
11598
11599 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
11600 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
11601
11602 *** ogonek
11603
11604 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
11605 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
11606 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
11607 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
11608 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
11609 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
11610 instance) and vice versa.
11611
11612 To use this package load it using
11613 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
11614 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
11615 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
11616 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
11617 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
11618 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
11619
11620 *** Interface to ph.
11621
11622 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
11623
11624 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
11625 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
11626 these servers.
11627
11628 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
11629
11630 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
11631 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
11632 while the real cursor does not move.
11633
11634 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
11635 for visiting your favorite web sites.
11636
11637 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
11638 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
11639
11640 ** movemail change
11641
11642 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
11643 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
11644 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
11645 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
11646
11647 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
11648 \f
11649 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
11650
11651 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
11652
11653 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
11654 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
11655 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
11656 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
11657 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
11658
11659 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
11660 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
11661 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
11662 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
11663 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
11664 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
11665 \f
11666 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
11667
11668 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
11669 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
11670 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
11671 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
11672
11673 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
11674 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
11675
11676 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
11677 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
11678 "win".
11679
11680 ** Basic Lisp changes
11681
11682 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
11683 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
11684
11685 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
11686 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
11687 or by the user.
11688
11689 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
11690
11691 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
11692
11693 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
11694 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
11695
11696 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
11697 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
11698 its argument.
11699
11700 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
11701
11702 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
11703
11704 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
11705
11706 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
11707 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
11708 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
11709 `format' function.
11710
11711 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
11712 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
11713 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
11714
11715 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
11716 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
11717 adding one of these suffixes.
11718
11719 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
11720 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
11721 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
11722
11723 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
11724 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
11725
11726 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
11727
11728 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
11729 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
11730
11731 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
11732 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
11733
11734 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
11735
11736 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
11737 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
11738
11739 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
11740 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
11741 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
11742 works using `save-current-buffer'.
11743
11744 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
11745 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
11746 of the last form.
11747
11748 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
11749 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
11750 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
11751 as the last form.
11752
11753 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
11754 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
11755 matches.
11756
11757 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
11758
11759 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
11760 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
11761 Then it returns that string.
11762
11763 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
11764
11765 (with-output-to-string
11766 (princ "The buffer is ")
11767 (princ (buffer-name)))
11768
11769 returns "The buffer is foo".
11770
11771 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
11772 is non-nil.
11773
11774 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
11775 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
11776 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
11777
11778 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
11779 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
11780
11781 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
11782 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
11783 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
11784 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
11785 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
11786 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
11787
11788 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
11789 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
11790 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
11791 characters".
11792
11793 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
11794 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
11795 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
11796 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
11797 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
11798
11799 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
11800 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
11801 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
11802 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
11803
11804 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
11805 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
11806
11807 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
11808
11809 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
11810 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
11811 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
11812 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
11813 guaranteed.
11814
11815 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
11816 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
11817 character).
11818
11819 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
11820
11821 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
11822 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
11823 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
11824 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
11825 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
11826
11827 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
11828
11829 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
11830 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
11831 more than the number of characters.
11832
11833 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
11834 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
11835 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
11836 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
11837 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
11838 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
11839
11840 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
11841 and returns a string containing those characters.
11842
11843 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
11844 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
11845 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
11846 character, sref signals an error.
11847
11848 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
11849 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
11850 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
11851
11852 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
11853 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
11854 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
11855
11856 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
11857 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
11858 to a vector of the characters in it.
11859
11860 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
11861 of a string. You call it as follows:
11862
11863 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
11864
11865 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
11866 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
11867 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
11868 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
11869 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
11870
11871 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
11872 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
11873
11874 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
11875 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
11876
11877 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
11878 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
11879 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
11880 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
11881
11882 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
11883
11884 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
11885
11886 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
11887 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
11888 are not included in the resulting value.
11889
11890 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
11891 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
11892 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
11893 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
11894
11895 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
11896 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
11897 character extends across that column), then the padding character
11898 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
11899 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
11900 column START-COLUMN.
11901
11902 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
11903 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
11904 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
11905 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
11906 changed text, before the change.
11907
11908 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
11909 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
11910 one character set for each script, not for each language.
11911
11912 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
11913
11914 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
11915
11916 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
11917 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
11918
11919 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
11920 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
11921 which identify the character within that character set.
11922
11923 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
11924 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
11925 opposite of split-char.
11926
11927 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
11928 of all the characters between BEG and END.
11929
11930 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
11931 of all the characters in a string.
11932
11933 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
11934 and specifying coding systems.
11935
11936 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
11937 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
11938 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
11939 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
11940 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
11941 as what to do about code conversion.)
11942
11943 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
11944 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
11945
11946 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
11947 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
11948 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
11949
11950 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
11951 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
11952 to match against a file name.
11953
11954 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
11955 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
11956 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
11957 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
11958 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
11959 specifies the coding system for encoding.
11960
11961 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
11962 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
11963
11964 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
11965 the coding system to use for network sockets.
11966
11967 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
11968 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
11969 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
11970 service names.
11971
11972 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
11973 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
11974 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
11975 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
11976 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
11977 specifies the coding system for encoding.
11978
11979 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
11980 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
11981
11982 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
11983 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
11984 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
11985 start the subprocess.
11986
11987 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
11988 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
11989 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
11990 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
11991 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
11992
11993 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
11994 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
11995 subprocess.
11996
11997 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
11998 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
11999 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
12000 connection permanently or until overridden.
12001
12002 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
12003 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
12004 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
12005 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
12006 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
12007 system for one operation at a time.
12008
12009 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
12010 files, subprocesses or network connections.
12011
12012 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
12013 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
12014 The value is a cons cell,
12015 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
12016 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
12017 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
12018 input to the subprocess.
12019
12020 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
12021 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
12022
12023 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
12024 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
12025 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
12026
12027 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
12028 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
12029 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
12030 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
12031 customization.
12032
12033 Thus, instead of writing
12034
12035 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
12036 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
12037
12038 you would now write this:
12039
12040 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
12041 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
12042 :type 'boolean
12043 :group foo)
12044
12045 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
12046 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
12047 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
12048 for a description of them.
12049
12050 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
12051 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
12052
12053 (defgroup ispell nil
12054 "Spell checking using Ispell."
12055 :group 'processes)
12056
12057 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
12058 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
12059 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
12060 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
12061 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
12062
12063 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
12064 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
12065 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
12066 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
12067 first-level subgroups.
12068
12069 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
12070
12071 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
12072 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
12073
12074 ** easy-mmode
12075
12076 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
12077 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
12078 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
12079 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
12080 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
12081 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
12082
12083 ** Text property changes
12084
12085 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
12086 text property.
12087
12088 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
12089 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
12090 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
12091 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
12092 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
12093
12094 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
12095 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
12096 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
12097 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
12098
12099 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
12100 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
12101 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
12102
12103 ** Changes in invisibility features
12104
12105 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
12106 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
12107 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
12108 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
12109 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
12110 make the overlay visible.
12111
12112 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
12113 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
12114 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
12115 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
12116 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
12117 t when it should hide it.
12118
12119 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
12120
12121 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
12122 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
12123 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
12124 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
12125 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
12126 Here is an example of how to do this:
12127
12128 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
12129 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
12130 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
12131 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
12132
12133 ...
12134 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
12135
12136 ...
12137 ;; When done with the overlays:
12138 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
12139 ;; Or respectively:
12140 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
12141
12142 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
12143
12144 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
12145 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
12146 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
12147 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
12148
12149 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
12150 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
12151 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
12152
12153 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
12154 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
12155
12156 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
12157 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
12158
12159 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
12160 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
12161 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
12162
12163 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
12164 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
12165 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
12166 determine the syntax type of the character.
12167
12168 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
12169 of the current buffer.
12170
12171 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
12172 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
12173 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
12174
12175 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
12176 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
12177 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
12178 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
12179 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
12180
12181 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
12182 text property.
12183
12184 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
12185 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
12186 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
12187
12188 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
12189 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
12190 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
12191 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
12192 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
12193
12194 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
12195 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
12196 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
12197
12198 ** Changes in face features
12199
12200 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
12201 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
12202
12203 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
12204 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
12205
12206 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
12207 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
12208
12209 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
12210 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
12211
12212 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
12213 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
12214 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
12215 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
12216 overlay property).
12217
12218 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
12219 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
12220
12221 ** Changes in file-handling functions
12222
12223 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
12224 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
12225 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
12226 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
12227
12228 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
12229 begins with ~.
12230
12231 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
12232 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
12233
12234 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
12235 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
12236
12237 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
12238 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
12239
12240 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
12241 character code conversion as well as other things.
12242
12243 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
12244 (formerly it did not).
12245
12246 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
12247 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
12248
12249 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
12250 instead of constant strings.
12251
12252 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
12253 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
12254 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
12255
12256 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
12257 in the same way as before.
12258
12259 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
12260 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
12261 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
12262
12263 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
12264 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
12265 else, and returns nil.
12266
12267 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
12268 directory cannot be listed.
12269
12270 ** Changes in minibuffer input
12271
12272 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
12273 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
12274 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
12275 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
12276 ways:
12277
12278 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
12279 It is available through the history command M-n.
12280
12281 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
12282 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
12283 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
12284 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
12285 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
12286
12287 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
12288 argument in this way.
12289
12290 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
12291 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
12292 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
12293
12294 ** Echo area features
12295
12296 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
12297 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
12298 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
12299 after the echo area is cleared.
12300
12301 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
12302 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
12303
12304 ** Keyboard input features
12305
12306 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
12307 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
12308
12309 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
12310 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
12311 by keyboard macros.
12312
12313 ** Frame-related changes
12314
12315 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
12316 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
12317 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
12318
12319 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
12320 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
12321 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
12322
12323 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12324 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
12325 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
12326 in the selected frame.
12327
12328 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
12329 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
12330 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
12331
12332 ** X Windows features
12333
12334 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
12335 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
12336 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
12337
12338 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
12339 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
12340
12341 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
12342 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
12343 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
12344
12345 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
12346 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
12347
12348 ** Subprocess features
12349
12350 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
12351 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
12352 automatically.
12353
12354 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
12355 and returns the output from the command as a string.
12356
12357 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
12358 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
12359
12360 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
12361 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
12362
12363 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
12364 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
12365 goes after the other menu items.
12366
12367 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
12368 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
12369 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
12370 are in use.
12371
12372 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
12373 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
12374
12375 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
12376 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
12377 form.
12378
12379 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
12380 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
12381 but its hook is still run.
12382
12383 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
12384 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
12385
12386 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
12387 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
12388 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
12389
12390 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
12391 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
12392 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
12393 warned.
12394
12395 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
12396 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
12397
12398 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
12399 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
12400 functions like display-time.
12401
12402 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
12403 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
12404
12405 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
12406 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
12407 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
12408
12409 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
12410 if there is an error in compilation.
12411
12412 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
12413 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
12414 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
12415 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
12416
12417 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
12418 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
12419 the *scratch* buffer.
12420
12421 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
12422 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
12423 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
12424 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
12425
12426 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
12427 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
12428 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
12429
12430 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
12431 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
12432 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
12433 and compose-mail-other-frame.
12434
12435 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
12436 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
12437 full name of the specified user will be returned.
12438
12439 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
12440 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
12441 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
12442 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
12443 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
12444 files at all.
12445
12446 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
12447 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
12448 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
12449 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
12450
12451 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
12452 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
12453 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
12454 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
12455
12456 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
12457
12458 ** imenu.el changes.
12459
12460 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
12461 item from menu created by imenu.
12462
12463 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
12464 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
12465 select one of those items.
12466 \f
12467 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
12468
12469 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
12470 Copyright information:
12471
12472 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12473
12474 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
12475 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
12476 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
12477 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
12478
12479 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
12480 of this document, or of portions of it,
12481 under the above conditions, provided also that they
12482 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
12483 \f
12484 Local variables:
12485 mode: outline
12486 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
12487 end:
12488
12489 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793